1 //===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2 //
3 // The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 // This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
14 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
15 #include "CXXABI.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
29 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
30 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
31 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
32 #include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
33 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
34 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
35 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
37 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
38 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
39 #include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
40 #include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
41 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
42 #include <map>
43
44 using namespace clang;
45
46 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
48 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
50 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
52 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
54 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
56 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58
59 enum FloatingRank {
60 HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
61 };
62
getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl * D) const63 RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
64 if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65 ExternalSource->ReadComments();
66
67 #ifndef NDEBUG
68 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69 assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71 #endif
72
73 CommentsLoaded = true;
74 }
75
76 assert(D);
77
78 // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79 if (D->isImplicit())
80 return nullptr;
81
82 // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
85 return nullptr;
86 }
87
88 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89 if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90 VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
91 return nullptr;
92 }
93
94 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95 if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
96 return nullptr;
97 }
98
99 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102 if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103 TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
104 return nullptr;
105 }
106
107 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108 if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
109 return nullptr;
110 }
111 if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112 // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113 // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114 if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
115 return nullptr;
116 }
117 // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
119 return nullptr;
120
121 // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122 // documentation.
123 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124 isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125 isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
126 return nullptr;
127
128 ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
129
130 // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131 if (RawComments.empty())
132 return nullptr;
133
134 // Find declaration location.
135 // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136 // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137 // location".
138 // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139 // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140 SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
142 isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
143 isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144 isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
145 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
146 else {
147 DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
148 if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150 // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151 // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152 // the "declaration location".
153 DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154 } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155 // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156 // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157 // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl. In that
158 // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159 // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160 if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161 TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162 DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163 }
164 }
165 }
166
167 // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168 // can't find the comment.
169 if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
170 return nullptr;
171
172 // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
173 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174 {
175 // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176 // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177 // first.
178 RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179 SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180 LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
181 BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182 ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183 bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184 if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185 MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186 Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187 }
188
189 if (Found) {
190 Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191 assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193 } else {
194 // Slow path.
195 Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196 &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197 }
198 }
199
200 // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201 // file buffer.
202 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203
204 // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205 if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
206 (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
207 (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
208 isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
209 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
210 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
211 // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212 // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213 if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214 SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215 == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216 CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
217 return *Comment;
218 }
219 }
220
221 // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222 // Let's look at the previous comment.
223 if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
224 return nullptr;
225 --Comment;
226
227 // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
228 if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
229 return nullptr;
230
231 // Decompose the end of the comment.
232 std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
233 = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
234
235 // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236 // aren't related.
237 if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
238 return nullptr;
239
240 // Get the corresponding buffer.
241 bool Invalid = false;
242 const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243 &Invalid).data();
244 if (Invalid)
245 return nullptr;
246
247 // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248 StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249 DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250
251 // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252 // comment and declaration.
253 if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
254 return nullptr;
255
256 return *Comment;
257 }
258
259 namespace {
260 /// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261 /// refer to the actual template.
262 /// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl * D)263 const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
264 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
265 // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
266 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
267 return FTD;
268
269 // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270 if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271 return D;
272
273 // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274 if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275 return FTD;
276
277 // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278 if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279 FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280 return MemberDecl;
281
282 return D;
283 }
284 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285 // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286 // template?
287 if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288 if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289 return MemberDecl;
290
291 return D;
292 }
293 if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294 // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295 if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296 return CTD;
297
298 // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299 // specialization?
300 if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301 dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302 if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303 return D;
304 llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305 ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306 PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307 return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308 static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309 static_cast<const Decl*>(
310 PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311 }
312
313 // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314 if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315 CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316 return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317
318 return D;
319 }
320 if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321 // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322 if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323 return MemberDecl;
324
325 return D;
326 }
327 // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
328 return D;
329 }
330 } // unnamed namespace
331
getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(const Decl * D,const Decl ** OriginalDecl) const332 const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333 const Decl *D,
334 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
335 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
336
337 // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338 {
339 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340 RedeclComments.find(D);
341 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
343 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344 if (OriginalDecl)
345 *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
346 return Raw.getRaw();
347 }
348 }
349 }
350
351 // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
352 const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353 const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
354 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
355 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
356 RedeclComments.find(I);
357 if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358 const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359 if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360 RC = Raw.getRaw();
361 OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
362 break;
363 }
364 } else {
365 RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366 OriginalDeclForRC = I;
367 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368 if (RC) {
369 Raw.setRaw(RC);
370 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
371 } else
372 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
373 Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
374 RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
375 if (RC)
376 break;
377 }
378 }
379
380 // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
381 assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
382
383 if (OriginalDecl)
384 *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
385
386 // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
387 RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
388 Raw.setRaw(RC);
389 Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
390 Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
391
392 for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
393 RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
394 if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
395 R = Raw;
396 }
397
398 return RC;
399 }
400
addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl * ObjCMethod,SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl * > & Redeclared)401 static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
402 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
403 const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
404 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
405 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
406 if (!ID)
407 return;
408 // Add redeclared method here.
409 for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
410 if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
411 Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
412 ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
413 Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
414 }
415 }
416 }
417
cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment * FC,const Decl * D) const418 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
419 const Decl *D) const {
420 comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
421 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
422 ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
423 ThisDeclInfo->fill();
424 ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
425 if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
426 ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
427 comments::FullComment *CFC =
428 new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
429 ThisDeclInfo);
430 return CFC;
431
432 }
433
getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl * D) const434 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
435 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
436 return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
437 }
438
getCommentForDecl(const Decl * D,const Preprocessor * PP) const439 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
440 const Decl *D,
441 const Preprocessor *PP) const {
442 if (D->isInvalidDecl())
443 return nullptr;
444 D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
445
446 const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
447 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
448 ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
449
450 if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
451 if (Canonical != D) {
452 comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
453 comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
454 return CFC;
455 }
456 return Pos->second;
457 }
458
459 const Decl *OriginalDecl;
460
461 const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
462 if (!RC) {
463 if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
464 SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
465 const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
466 if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
467 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
468 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
469 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
470 if (OMD)
471 addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
472 getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
473 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
474 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
475 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
476 }
477 else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
478 // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
479 // does not have one of its own.
480 QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
481 if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
482 if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
483 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
484 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
485 }
486 else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
487 while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
488 IC = IC->getSuperClass();
489 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
490 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
491 }
492 }
493 else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
494 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
495 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
496 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
497 }
498 else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
499 if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
500 return nullptr;
501 // Check non-virtual bases.
502 for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
503 if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
504 continue;
505 QualType Ty = I.getType();
506 if (Ty.isNull())
507 continue;
508 if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
509 if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
510 continue;
511
512 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
513 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
514 }
515 }
516 // Check virtual bases.
517 for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
518 if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
519 continue;
520 QualType Ty = I.getType();
521 if (Ty.isNull())
522 continue;
523 if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
524 if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
525 continue;
526 if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
527 return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
528 }
529 }
530 }
531 return nullptr;
532 }
533
534 // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
535 // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl. This is important
536 // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
537 // different across redeclarations.
538 if (D != OriginalDecl)
539 return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
540
541 comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
542 ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
543 return FC;
544 }
545
546 void
Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID & ID,TemplateTemplateParmDecl * Parm)547 ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
548 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
549 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
550 ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
551 ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
552
553 TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
554 ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
555 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
556 PEnd = Params->end();
557 P != PEnd; ++P) {
558 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
559 ID.AddInteger(0);
560 ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
561 continue;
562 }
563
564 if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
565 ID.AddInteger(1);
566 ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
567 ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
568 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
569 ID.AddBoolean(true);
570 ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
571 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
572 QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
573 ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
574 }
575 } else
576 ID.AddBoolean(false);
577 continue;
578 }
579
580 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
581 ID.AddInteger(2);
582 Profile(ID, TTP);
583 }
584 }
585
586 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TemplateTemplateParmDecl * TTP) const587 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
588 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
589 // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
590 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
591 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
592 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
593 CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
594 = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
595 if (Canonical)
596 return Canonical->getParam();
597
598 // Build a canonical template parameter list.
599 TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
600 SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
601 CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
602 for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
603 PEnd = Params->end();
604 P != PEnd; ++P) {
605 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
606 CanonParams.push_back(
607 TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
608 SourceLocation(),
609 SourceLocation(),
610 TTP->getDepth(),
611 TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
612 TTP->isParameterPack()));
613 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
614 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
615 QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
616 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
617 NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
618 if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
619 SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
620 SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
621 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
622 ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
623 ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
624 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
625 }
626
627 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
628 SourceLocation(),
629 SourceLocation(),
630 NTTP->getDepth(),
631 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
632 T,
633 TInfo,
634 ExpandedTypes.data(),
635 ExpandedTypes.size(),
636 ExpandedTInfos.data());
637 } else {
638 Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
639 SourceLocation(),
640 SourceLocation(),
641 NTTP->getDepth(),
642 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
643 T,
644 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645 TInfo);
646 }
647 CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648
649 } else
650 CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651 cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652 }
653
654 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
655 = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
656 SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
657 TTP->getPosition(),
658 TTP->isParameterPack(),
659 nullptr,
660 TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
661 SourceLocation(),
662 CanonParams.data(),
663 CanonParams.size(),
664 SourceLocation()));
665
666 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
667 Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
668 assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
669 (void)Canonical;
670
671 // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
672 Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
673 CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
674 return CanonTTP;
675 }
676
createCXXABI(const TargetInfo & T)677 CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
678 if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
679
680 switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
681 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
682 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
683 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
684 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
685 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
686 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
687 return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
688 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
689 return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
690 }
691 llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
692 }
693
getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo & T,const LangOptions & LOpts)694 static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
695 const LangOptions &LOpts) {
696 if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
697 // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
698 // language-specific address space.
699 static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
700 1, // opencl_global
701 2, // opencl_local
702 3, // opencl_constant
703 4, // opencl_generic
704 5, // cuda_device
705 6, // cuda_constant
706 7 // cuda_shared
707 };
708 return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
709 } else {
710 return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
711 }
712 }
713
isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo & TI,const LangOptions & LangOpts)714 static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
715 const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
716 switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
717 case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
718 return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
719 case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
720 return true;
721 case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
722 return false;
723 }
724 llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
725 }
726
ASTContext(LangOptions & LOpts,SourceManager & SM,IdentifierTable & idents,SelectorTable & sels,Builtin::Context & builtins)727 ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
728 IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
729 Builtin::Context &builtins)
730 : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
731 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
732 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
733 GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr),
734 UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
735 BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr), ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr),
736 ObjCClassDecl(nullptr), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
737 CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr),
738 FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr),
739 ucontext_tDecl(nullptr), BlockDescriptorType(nullptr),
740 BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr), cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr),
741 FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(), ExternCContext(nullptr),
742 SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
743 SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
744 AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
745 Idents(idents), Selectors(sels), BuiltinInfo(builtins),
746 DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr), Listener(nullptr),
747 Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
748 CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
749 TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
750 }
751
~ASTContext()752 ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
753 ReleaseParentMapEntries();
754
755 // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
756 // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
757 ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
758
759 // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
760 for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
761 E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
762 for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
763 (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
764
765 // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
766 // because they can contain DenseMaps.
767 for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
768 const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
769 I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
770 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
771 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
772 R->Destroy(*this);
773
774 for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
775 I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
776 // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
777 if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
778 R->Destroy(*this);
779 }
780
781 for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
782 AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
783 A != AEnd; ++A)
784 A->second->~AttrVec();
785
786 llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
787 }
788
ReleaseParentMapEntries()789 void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
790 if (!AllParents) return;
791 for (const auto &Entry : *AllParents) {
792 if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
793 delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
794 } else {
795 assert(Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>());
796 delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
797 }
798 }
799 }
800
AddDeallocation(void (* Callback)(void *),void * Data)801 void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
802 Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
803 }
804
805 void
setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source)806 ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
807 ExternalSource = Source;
808 }
809
PrintStats() const810 void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
811 llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
812 llvm::errs() << " " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
813
814 unsigned counts[] = {
815 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
816 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
817 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
818 0 // Extra
819 };
820
821 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
822 Type *T = Types[i];
823 counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
824 }
825
826 unsigned Idx = 0;
827 unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
828 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) \
829 if (counts[Idx]) \
830 llvm::errs() << " " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name \
831 << " types\n"; \
832 TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type); \
833 ++Idx;
834 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
835 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
836
837 llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
838
839 // Implicit special member functions.
840 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
841 << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
842 << " implicit default constructors created\n";
843 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
844 << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
845 << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
846 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
847 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
848 << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
849 << " implicit move constructors created\n";
850 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
851 << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
852 << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
853 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
854 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
855 << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
856 << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
857 llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
858 << NumImplicitDestructors
859 << " implicit destructors created\n";
860
861 if (ExternalSource) {
862 llvm::errs() << "\n";
863 ExternalSource->PrintStats();
864 }
865
866 BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
867 }
868
mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl * ND,Module * M,bool NotifyListeners)869 void ASTContext::mergeDefinitionIntoModule(NamedDecl *ND, Module *M,
870 bool NotifyListeners) {
871 if (NotifyListeners)
872 if (auto *Listener = getASTMutationListener())
873 Listener->RedefinedHiddenDefinition(ND, M);
874
875 if (getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
876 MergedDefModules[ND].push_back(M);
877 else
878 ND->setHidden(false);
879 }
880
deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl * ND)881 void ASTContext::deduplicateMergedDefinitonsFor(NamedDecl *ND) {
882 auto It = MergedDefModules.find(ND);
883 if (It == MergedDefModules.end())
884 return;
885
886 auto &Merged = It->second;
887 llvm::DenseSet<Module*> Found;
888 for (Module *&M : Merged)
889 if (!Found.insert(M).second)
890 M = nullptr;
891 Merged.erase(std::remove(Merged.begin(), Merged.end(), nullptr), Merged.end());
892 }
893
getExternCContextDecl() const894 ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
895 if (!ExternCContext)
896 ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
897
898 return ExternCContext;
899 }
900
buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const901 RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
902 RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
903 SourceLocation Loc;
904 RecordDecl *NewDecl;
905 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
906 NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
907 Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
908 else
909 NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
910 &Idents.get(Name));
911 NewDecl->setImplicit();
912 NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
913 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
914 return NewDecl;
915 }
916
buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,StringRef Name) const917 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
918 StringRef Name) const {
919 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
920 TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
921 const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
922 SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
923 NewDecl->setImplicit();
924 return NewDecl;
925 }
926
getInt128Decl() const927 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
928 if (!Int128Decl)
929 Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
930 return Int128Decl;
931 }
932
getUInt128Decl() const933 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
934 if (!UInt128Decl)
935 UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
936 return UInt128Decl;
937 }
938
getFloat128StubType() const939 TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
940 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
941 if (!Float128StubDecl)
942 Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
943
944 return Float128StubDecl;
945 }
946
InitBuiltinType(CanQualType & R,BuiltinType::Kind K)947 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
948 BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
949 R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
950 Types.push_back(Ty);
951 }
952
InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo & Target)953 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
954 assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
955 "Incorrect target reinitialization");
956 assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
957
958 this->Target = &Target;
959
960 ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
961 AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
962 AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
963
964 // C99 6.2.5p19.
965 InitBuiltinType(VoidTy, BuiltinType::Void);
966
967 // C99 6.2.5p2.
968 InitBuiltinType(BoolTy, BuiltinType::Bool);
969 // C99 6.2.5p3.
970 if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
971 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_S);
972 else
973 InitBuiltinType(CharTy, BuiltinType::Char_U);
974 // C99 6.2.5p4.
975 InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy, BuiltinType::SChar);
976 InitBuiltinType(ShortTy, BuiltinType::Short);
977 InitBuiltinType(IntTy, BuiltinType::Int);
978 InitBuiltinType(LongTy, BuiltinType::Long);
979 InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy, BuiltinType::LongLong);
980
981 // C99 6.2.5p6.
982 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy, BuiltinType::UChar);
983 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy, BuiltinType::UShort);
984 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy, BuiltinType::UInt);
985 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy, BuiltinType::ULong);
986 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy, BuiltinType::ULongLong);
987
988 // C99 6.2.5p10.
989 InitBuiltinType(FloatTy, BuiltinType::Float);
990 InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy, BuiltinType::Double);
991 InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy, BuiltinType::LongDouble);
992
993 // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
994 InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty, BuiltinType::Int128);
995 InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty, BuiltinType::UInt128);
996
997 // C++ 3.9.1p5
998 if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
999 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_S);
1000 else // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
1001 InitBuiltinType(WCharTy, BuiltinType::WChar_U);
1002 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
1003 WideCharTy = WCharTy;
1004 else {
1005 // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
1006 WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
1007 }
1008
1009 WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
1010
1011 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1012 InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty, BuiltinType::Char16);
1013 else // C99
1014 Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
1015
1016 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
1017 InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty, BuiltinType::Char32);
1018 else // C99
1019 Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
1020
1021 // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
1022 // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
1023 // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
1024 // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1025 // expressions.
1026 InitBuiltinType(DependentTy, BuiltinType::Dependent);
1027
1028 // Placeholder type for functions.
1029 InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy, BuiltinType::Overload);
1030
1031 // Placeholder type for bound members.
1032 InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy, BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1033
1034 // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1035 InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy, BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1036
1037 // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1038 InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy, BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1039
1040 // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1041 InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy, BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1042
1043 // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1044 InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy, BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1045
1046 // C99 6.2.5p11.
1047 FloatComplexTy = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1048 DoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1049 LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
1050
1051 // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
1052 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1053 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
1054 InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
1055
1056 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1057 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1058 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1059 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1060 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1061 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1062 InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
1063
1064 InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
1065 InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
1066 }
1067
1068 // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
1069 ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1070 SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
1071
1072 ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
1073
1074 ObjCSuperType = QualType();
1075
1076 // void * type
1077 VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
1078
1079 // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1080 InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy, BuiltinType::NullPtr);
1081
1082 // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1083 InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
1084
1085 // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1086 VaListTagTy = QualType();
1087 }
1088
getDiagnostics() const1089 DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
1090 return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1091 }
1092
getDeclAttrs(const Decl * D)1093 AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1094 AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1095 if (!Result) {
1096 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1097 Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1098 }
1099
1100 return *Result;
1101 }
1102
1103 /// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl * D)1104 void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1105 llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1106 if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1107 Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1108 DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1109 }
1110 }
1111
1112 // FIXME: Remove ?
1113 MemberSpecializationInfo *
getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl * Var)1114 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
1115 assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1116 return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1117 .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1118 }
1119
1120 ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl * Var)1121 ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1122 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1123 TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1124 if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1125 return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
1126
1127 return Pos->second;
1128 }
1129
1130 void
setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl * Inst,VarDecl * Tmpl,TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation)1131 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
1132 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1133 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
1134 assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1135 assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1136 setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1137 Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1138 }
1139
1140 void
setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl * Inst,TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI)1141 ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1142 TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1143 assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1144 "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1145 TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
1146 }
1147
getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(const FunctionDecl * FD)1148 FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1149 const FunctionDecl *FD){
1150 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1151 llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
1152 = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1153 if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
1154 return nullptr;
1155
1156 return Pos->second;
1157 }
1158
setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl * FD,FunctionDecl * Pattern)1159 void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1160 FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1161 assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1162 assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
1163 ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
1164 }
1165
1166 NamedDecl *
getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl * UUD)1167 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
1168 llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
1169 = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1170 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
1171 return nullptr;
1172
1173 return Pos->second;
1174 }
1175
1176 void
setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl * Inst,NamedDecl * Pattern)1177 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1178 assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1179 isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1180 isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1181 "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1182 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1183 InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1184 }
1185
1186 UsingShadowDecl *
getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl * Inst)1187 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1188 llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1189 = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1190 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
1191 return nullptr;
1192
1193 return Pos->second;
1194 }
1195
1196 void
setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl * Inst,UsingShadowDecl * Pattern)1197 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1198 UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1199 assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1200 InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1201 }
1202
getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl * Field)1203 FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1204 llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1205 = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1206 if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
1207 return nullptr;
1208
1209 return Pos->second;
1210 }
1211
setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl * Inst,FieldDecl * Tmpl)1212 void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1213 FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1214 assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1215 assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1216 assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1217 "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
1218
1219 InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1220 }
1221
1222 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl * Method) const1223 ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1224 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
1225 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1226 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1227 return nullptr;
1228
1229 return Pos->second.begin();
1230 }
1231
1232 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl * Method) const1233 ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1234 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
1235 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1236 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1237 return nullptr;
1238
1239 return Pos->second.end();
1240 }
1241
1242 unsigned
overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl * Method) const1243 ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1244 llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
1245 = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1246 if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1247 return 0;
1248
1249 return Pos->second.size();
1250 }
1251
addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl * Method,const CXXMethodDecl * Overridden)1252 void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1253 const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
1254 assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
1255 OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1256 }
1257
getOverriddenMethods(const NamedDecl * D,SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl * > & Overridden) const1258 void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1259 const NamedDecl *D,
1260 SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
1261 assert(D);
1262
1263 if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
1264 Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1265 overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
1266 return;
1267 }
1268
1269 const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1270 if (!Method)
1271 return;
1272
1273 SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1274 Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
1275 Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
1276 }
1277
addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl * Import)1278 void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1279 assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1280 assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1281 if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1282 FirstLocalImport = Import;
1283 LastLocalImport = Import;
1284 return;
1285 }
1286
1287 LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1288 LastLocalImport = Import;
1289 }
1290
1291 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1292 // Type Sizing and Analysis
1293 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1294
1295 /// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1296 /// scalar floating point type.
getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const1297 const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
1298 const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
1299 assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1300 switch (BT->getKind()) {
1301 default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
1302 case BuiltinType::Half: return Target->getHalfFormat();
1303 case BuiltinType::Float: return Target->getFloatFormat();
1304 case BuiltinType::Double: return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1305 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
1306 }
1307 }
1308
getDeclAlign(const Decl * D,bool ForAlignof) const1309 CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
1310 unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
1311
1312 bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1313 if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1314 Align = AlignFromAttr;
1315
1316 // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1317 // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1318 // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1319 //
1320 // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
1321 // ignore that possibility; Sema should diagnose it.
1322 if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1323 UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1324 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1325 } else {
1326 UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1327 }
1328 }
1329 else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1330 UseAlignAttrOnly =
1331 D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1332 cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1333
1334 // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1335 // else about the declaration and its type.
1336 if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
1337 // do nothing
1338
1339 } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
1340 QualType T = VD->getType();
1341 if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
1342 if (ForAlignof)
1343 T = RT->getPointeeType();
1344 else
1345 T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1346 }
1347 QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1348 if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
1349 // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1350 // large-array alignment on the target.
1351 if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
1352 unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1353 if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
1354 if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1355 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1356 else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1357 MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1358 Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1359 }
1360 }
1361 Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
1362 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1363 if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
1364 Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1365 }
1366 }
1367
1368 // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1369 // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1370 // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack). So calculate
1371 // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1372 // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
1373 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1374 const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1375 // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1376 if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1377 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
1378
1379 // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1380 unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1381
1382 // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1383 uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1384 if (Offset > 0) {
1385 // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1386 // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1387 uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1388 if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1389 FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1390 }
1391
1392 Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
1393 }
1394 }
1395 }
1396
1397 return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
1398 }
1399
1400 // getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1401 // chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned. This is
1402 // the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1403 // using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1404 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const1405 ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1406 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1407
1408 // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1409 // of a base-class subobject. We decide whether that's possible
1410 // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1411 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1412 if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1413 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1414 sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1415 }
1416 }
1417
1418 return sizeAndAlign;
1419 }
1420
1421 /// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1422 /// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1423 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext & Context,const ConstantArrayType * CAT)1424 static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1425 const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1426 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1427 Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1428 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
1429 assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1430 (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1431 "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1432 uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1433 unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
1434 if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1435 Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1436 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1437 return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1438 CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1439 }
1440
1441 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
getTypeInfoInChars(const Type * T) const1442 ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
1443 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1444 return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
1445 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1446 return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1447 toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
1448 }
1449
1450 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const1451 ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
1452 return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1453 }
1454
isAlignmentRequired(const Type * T) const1455 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1456 return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1457 }
1458
isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const1459 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1460 return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1461 }
1462
getTypeInfo(const Type * T) const1463 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1464 TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1465 if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1466 return I->second;
1467
1468 // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1469 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1470 MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
1471 return TI;
1472 }
1473
1474 /// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits. This
1475 /// method does not work on incomplete types.
1476 ///
1477 /// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1478 /// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1479 /// should take a QualType, &c.
getTypeInfoImpl(const Type * T) const1480 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1481 uint64_t Width = 0;
1482 unsigned Align = 8;
1483 bool AlignIsRequired = false;
1484 switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
1485 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
1486 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
1487 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
1488 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
1489 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) \
1490 case Type::Class: \
1491 assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here"); \
1492 return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
1493 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
1494 llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
1495
1496 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1497 case Type::FunctionProto:
1498 // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1499 Width = 0;
1500 Align = 32;
1501 break;
1502
1503 case Type::IncompleteArray:
1504 case Type::VariableArray:
1505 Width = 0;
1506 Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1507 break;
1508
1509 case Type::ConstantArray: {
1510 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
1511
1512 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
1513 uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
1514 assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
1515 "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
1516 Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1517 Align = EltInfo.Align;
1518 if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1519 getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1520 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1521 break;
1522 }
1523 case Type::ExtVector:
1524 case Type::Vector: {
1525 const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1526 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1527 Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
1528 Align = Width;
1529 // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1530 // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
1531 if (Align & (Align-1)) {
1532 Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1533 Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1534 }
1535 // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1536 uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1537 if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1538 Align = TargetVectorAlign;
1539 break;
1540 }
1541
1542 case Type::Builtin:
1543 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
1544 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
1545 case BuiltinType::Void:
1546 // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1547 Width = 0;
1548 Align = 8;
1549 break;
1550
1551 case BuiltinType::Bool:
1552 Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1553 Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
1554 break;
1555 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1556 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1557 case BuiltinType::UChar:
1558 case BuiltinType::SChar:
1559 Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1560 Align = Target->getCharAlign();
1561 break;
1562 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1563 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
1564 Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1565 Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
1566 break;
1567 case BuiltinType::Char16:
1568 Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1569 Align = Target->getChar16Align();
1570 break;
1571 case BuiltinType::Char32:
1572 Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1573 Align = Target->getChar32Align();
1574 break;
1575 case BuiltinType::UShort:
1576 case BuiltinType::Short:
1577 Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1578 Align = Target->getShortAlign();
1579 break;
1580 case BuiltinType::UInt:
1581 case BuiltinType::Int:
1582 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1583 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1584 break;
1585 case BuiltinType::ULong:
1586 case BuiltinType::Long:
1587 Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1588 Align = Target->getLongAlign();
1589 break;
1590 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
1591 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
1592 Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1593 Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
1594 break;
1595 case BuiltinType::Int128:
1596 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1597 Width = 128;
1598 Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1599 break;
1600 case BuiltinType::Half:
1601 Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1602 Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1603 break;
1604 case BuiltinType::Float:
1605 Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1606 Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
1607 break;
1608 case BuiltinType::Double:
1609 Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1610 Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
1611 break;
1612 case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
1613 Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1614 Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
1615 break;
1616 case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
1617 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1618 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); // == sizeof(void*)
1619 break;
1620 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1621 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1622 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
1623 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1624 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1625 break;
1626 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1627 // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1628 Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1629 Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1630 break;
1631 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
1632 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1633 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1634 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1635 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1636 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1637 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1638 // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1639 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1640 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1641 break;
1642 }
1643 break;
1644 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
1645 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1646 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1647 break;
1648 case Type::BlockPointer: {
1649 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1650 cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
1651 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1652 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1653 break;
1654 }
1655 case Type::LValueReference:
1656 case Type::RValueReference: {
1657 // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1658 // the pointer route.
1659 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1660 cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
1661 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1662 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1663 break;
1664 }
1665 case Type::Pointer: {
1666 unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
1667 Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1668 Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1669 break;
1670 }
1671 case Type::MemberPointer: {
1672 const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
1673 std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
1674 break;
1675 }
1676 case Type::Complex: {
1677 // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1678 // size.
1679 TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1680 Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1681 Align = EltInfo.Align;
1682 break;
1683 }
1684 case Type::ObjCObject:
1685 return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
1686 case Type::Adjusted:
1687 case Type::Decayed:
1688 return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
1689 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
1690 const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
1691 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
1692 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
1693 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1694 break;
1695 }
1696 case Type::Record:
1697 case Type::Enum: {
1698 const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1699
1700 if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
1701 Width = 8;
1702 Align = 8;
1703 break;
1704 }
1705
1706 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1707 const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1708 TypeInfo Info =
1709 getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1710 if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1711 Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1712 Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1713 }
1714 return Info;
1715 }
1716
1717 const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
1718 const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1719 const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
1720 Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
1721 Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1722 AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
1723 break;
1724 }
1725
1726 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
1727 return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1728 getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
1729
1730 case Type::Auto: {
1731 const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
1732 assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1733 "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
1734 return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
1735 }
1736
1737 case Type::Paren:
1738 return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1739
1740 case Type::Typedef: {
1741 const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
1742 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
1743 // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1744 // alignment we have. This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1745 // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
1746 if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
1747 Align = AttrAlign;
1748 AlignIsRequired = true;
1749 } else {
1750 Align = Info.Align;
1751 AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1752 }
1753 Width = Info.Width;
1754 break;
1755 }
1756
1757 case Type::Elaborated:
1758 return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
1759
1760 case Type::Attributed:
1761 return getTypeInfo(
1762 cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1763
1764 case Type::Atomic: {
1765 // Start with the base type information.
1766 TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1767 Width = Info.Width;
1768 Align = Info.Align;
1769
1770 // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1771 // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1772 // favorable to atomic operations:
1773 if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1774 // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1775 if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1776 Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1777
1778 // Set the alignment equal to the size.
1779 Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1780 }
1781 }
1782
1783 }
1784
1785 assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
1786 return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
1787 }
1788
getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const1789 unsigned ASTContext::getOpenMPDefaultSimdAlign(QualType T) const {
1790 unsigned SimdAlign = getTargetInfo().getSimdDefaultAlign();
1791 // Target ppc64 with QPX: simd default alignment for pointer to double is 32.
1792 if ((getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64 ||
1793 getTargetInfo().getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::ppc64le) &&
1794 getTargetInfo().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx" &&
1795 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
1796 SimdAlign = 256;
1797 return SimdAlign;
1798 }
1799
1800 /// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const1801 CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1802 return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1803 }
1804
1805 /// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const1806 int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1807 return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1808 }
1809
1810 /// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1811 /// This method does not work on incomplete types.
getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const1812 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1813 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
1814 }
getTypeSizeInChars(const Type * T) const1815 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
1816 return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
1817 }
1818
1819 /// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
1820 /// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const1821 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
1822 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
1823 }
getTypeAlignInChars(const Type * T) const1824 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
1825 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
1826 }
1827
1828 /// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1829 /// type for the current target in bits. This can be different than the ABI
1830 /// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1831 /// a data type.
getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type * T) const1832 unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
1833 TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1834 unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
1835
1836 T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1837
1838 // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
1839 if (T->isMemberPointerType())
1840 return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
1841
1842 if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1843 return ABIAlign; // Never overalign on XCore.
1844
1845 // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
1846 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
1847 T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1848 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
1849 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
1850 if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
1851 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1852 T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
1853 // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1854 // typedef declaration.
1855 if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
1856 return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
1857
1858 return ABIAlign;
1859 }
1860
1861 /// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
1862 /// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
1863 /// value is specified.
getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned(void) const1864 unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned(void) const {
1865 return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
1866 }
1867
1868 /// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1869 /// to a global variable of the specified type.
getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const1870 unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1871 return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1872 }
1873
1874 /// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1875 /// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const1876 CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1877 return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1878 }
1879
getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl * RD) const1880 CharUnits ASTContext::getOffsetOfBaseWithVBPtr(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
1881 CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::Zero();
1882 const ASTRecordLayout *Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(RD);
1883 while (const CXXRecordDecl *Base = Layout->getBaseSharingVBPtr()) {
1884 Offset += Layout->getBaseClassOffset(Base);
1885 Layout = &getASTRecordLayout(Base);
1886 }
1887 return Offset;
1888 }
1889
1890 /// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1891 /// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1892 /// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1893 /// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1894 /// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
1895 ///
DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl * OI,bool leafClass,SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl * > & Ivars) const1896 void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1897 bool leafClass,
1898 SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
1899 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1900 DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1901 if (!leafClass) {
1902 for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1903 Ivars.push_back(I);
1904 } else {
1905 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
1906 for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
1907 Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1908 Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1909 }
1910 }
1911
1912 /// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1913 /// those inherited by it.
CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl * CDecl,llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *,8> & Protocols)1914 void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
1915 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
1916 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
1917 // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1918 // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
1919 for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
1920 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
1921 }
1922
1923 // Categories of this Interface.
1924 for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1925 CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
1926
1927 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1928 while (SD) {
1929 CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1930 SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1931 }
1932 } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
1933 for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
1934 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
1935 }
1936 } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
1937 // Insert the protocol.
1938 if (!Protocols.insert(
1939 const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl *>(OP->getCanonicalDecl())).second)
1940 return;
1941
1942 for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols())
1943 CollectInheritedProtocols(Proto, Protocols);
1944 }
1945 }
1946
CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl * OI) const1947 unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
1948 unsigned count = 0;
1949 // Count ivars declared in class extension.
1950 for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
1951 count += Ext->ivar_size();
1952
1953 // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation. This
1954 // includes synthesized ivars.
1955 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
1956 count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1957
1958 return count;
1959 }
1960
isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr * E)1961 bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1962 if (!E)
1963 return false;
1964
1965 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1966 if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1967
1968 if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1969 E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1970 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1971 return true;
1972
1973 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1974 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1975
1976 return false;
1977 }
1978
1979 /// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl * D)1980 ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1981 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1982 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1983 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1984 return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
1985 return nullptr;
1986 }
1987 /// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl * D)1988 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1989 llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1990 I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1991 if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1992 return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
1993 return nullptr;
1994 }
1995
1996 /// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl * IFaceD,ObjCImplementationDecl * ImplD)1997 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1998 ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1999 assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2000 ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
2001 }
2002 /// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl * CatD,ObjCCategoryImplDecl * ImplD)2003 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
2004 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
2005 assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
2006 ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
2007 }
2008
getObjContainingInterface(const NamedDecl * ND) const2009 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
2010 const NamedDecl *ND) const {
2011 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
2012 dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2013 return ID;
2014 if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
2015 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2016 return CD->getClassInterface();
2017 if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
2018 dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
2019 return IMD->getClassInterface();
2020
2021 return nullptr;
2022 }
2023
2024 /// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
2025 /// none exists.
getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl * VD)2026 Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
2027 assert(VD && "Passed null params");
2028 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2029 "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
2030 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
2031 I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
2032 return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
2033 }
2034
2035 /// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl * VD,Expr * Init)2036 void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
2037 assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
2038 assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
2039 "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
2040 BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
2041 }
2042
CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,unsigned DataSize) const2043 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
2044 unsigned DataSize) const {
2045 if (!DataSize)
2046 DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2047 else
2048 assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
2049 "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
2050
2051 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2052 (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2053 new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2054 return TInfo;
2055 }
2056
getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,SourceLocation L) const2057 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
2058 SourceLocation L) const {
2059 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
2060 DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
2061 return DI;
2062 }
2063
2064 const ASTRecordLayout &
getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl * D) const2065 ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
2066 return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
2067 }
2068
2069 const ASTRecordLayout &
getASTObjCImplementationLayout(const ObjCImplementationDecl * D) const2070 ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2071 const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
2072 return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2073 }
2074
2075 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2076 // Type creation/memoization methods
2077 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2078
2079 QualType
getExtQualType(const Type * baseType,Qualifiers quals) const2080 ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2081 unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2082 quals.removeFastQualifiers();
2083
2084 // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2085 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2086 ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
2087 void *insertPos = nullptr;
2088 if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2089 assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2090 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
2091 }
2092
2093 // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2094 QualType canon;
2095 if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2096 SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
2097 canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2098 canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
2099
2100 // Re-find the insert position.
2101 (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2102 }
2103
2104 ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2105 ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2106 return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
2107 }
2108
2109 QualType
getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T,unsigned AddressSpace) const2110 ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
2111 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2112 if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
2113 return T;
2114
2115 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2116 // into one ExtQuals node.
2117 QualifierCollector Quals;
2118 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2119
2120 // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2121 // another one.
2122 assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2123 "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2124 Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
2125
2126 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
2127 }
2128
getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const2129 QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
2130 Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
2131 QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2132 if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
2133 return T;
2134
2135 if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2136 QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
2137 if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
2138 QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2139 return getPointerType(ResultType);
2140 }
2141 }
2142
2143 // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2144 // into one ExtQuals node.
2145 QualifierCollector Quals;
2146 const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2147
2148 // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2149 // another one.
2150 assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2151 "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2152 Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
2153
2154 return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
2155 }
2156
adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType * T,FunctionType::ExtInfo Info)2157 const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2158 FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2159 if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2160 return T;
2161
2162 QualType Result;
2163 if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
2164 Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
2165 } else {
2166 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2167 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2168 EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
2169 Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
2170 }
2171
2172 return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2173 }
2174
adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl * FD,QualType ResultType)2175 void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2176 QualType ResultType) {
2177 FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2178 while (true) {
2179 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2180 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2181 FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
2182 if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2183 FD = Next;
2184 else
2185 break;
2186 }
2187 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2188 L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
2189 }
2190
2191 /// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2192 /// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2193 /// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2194 /// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(ASTContext & Context,QualType Orig,const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo & ESI)2195 static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2196 ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2197 const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2198 // Might have some parens.
2199 if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2200 return Context.getParenType(
2201 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2202
2203 // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2204 if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2205 return Context.getAttributedType(
2206 AT->getAttrKind(),
2207 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2208 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2209 ESI));
2210
2211 // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2212 // specification.
2213 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2214 return Context.getFunctionType(
2215 Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2216 Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2217 }
2218
adjustExceptionSpec(FunctionDecl * FD,const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo & ESI,bool AsWritten)2219 void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2220 FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2221 bool AsWritten) {
2222 // Update the type.
2223 QualType Updated =
2224 getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2225 FD->setType(Updated);
2226
2227 if (!AsWritten)
2228 return;
2229
2230 // Update the type in the type source information too.
2231 if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2232 // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2233 // the type-as-written too.
2234 if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2235 Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2236
2237 // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2238 // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2239 // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2240 assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2241 TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2242 "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2243 TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2244 }
2245 }
2246
2247 /// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2248 /// number with the specified element type.
getComplexType(QualType T) const2249 QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
2250 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2251 // structure.
2252 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2253 ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
2254
2255 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2256 if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2257 return QualType(CT, 0);
2258
2259 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2260 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2261 QualType Canonical;
2262 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
2263 Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
2264
2265 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2266 ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2267 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2268 }
2269 ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
2270 Types.push_back(New);
2271 ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2272 return QualType(New, 0);
2273 }
2274
2275 /// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2276 /// the specified type.
getPointerType(QualType T) const2277 QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
2278 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2279 // structure.
2280 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2281 PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
2282
2283 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2284 if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2285 return QualType(PT, 0);
2286
2287 // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2288 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2289 QualType Canonical;
2290 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
2291 Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
2292
2293 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2294 PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2295 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2296 }
2297 PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
2298 Types.push_back(New);
2299 PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2300 return QualType(New, 0);
2301 }
2302
getAdjustedType(QualType Orig,QualType New) const2303 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2304 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2305 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
2306 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2307 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2308 if (AT)
2309 return QualType(AT, 0);
2310
2311 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2312
2313 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2314 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2315 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
2316
2317 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2318 AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2319 Types.push_back(AT);
2320 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2321 return QualType(AT, 0);
2322 }
2323
getDecayedType(QualType T) const2324 QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2325 assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2326
2327 QualType Decayed;
2328
2329 // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2330 // A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2331 // adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2332 // qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2333 // the array type derivation.
2334 if (T->isArrayType())
2335 Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2336
2337 // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2338 // A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2339 // shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2340 // in 6.3.2.1.
2341 if (T->isFunctionType())
2342 Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2343
2344 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2345 AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
2346 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2347 AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2348 if (AT)
2349 return QualType(AT, 0);
2350
2351 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2352
2353 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2354 AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2355 assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
2356
2357 AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2358 Types.push_back(AT);
2359 AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2360 return QualType(AT, 0);
2361 }
2362
2363 /// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
2364 /// a pointer to the specified block.
getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const2365 QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
2366 assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2367 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
2368 // structure.
2369 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2370 BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
2371
2372 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2373 if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2374 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2375 return QualType(PT, 0);
2376
2377 // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2378 // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2379 QualType Canonical;
2380 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
2381 Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
2382
2383 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2384 BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2385 BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2386 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2387 }
2388 BlockPointerType *New
2389 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
2390 Types.push_back(New);
2391 BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2392 return QualType(New, 0);
2393 }
2394
2395 /// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2396 /// lvalue reference to the specified type.
2397 QualType
getLValueReferenceType(QualType T,bool SpelledAsLValue) const2398 ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
2399 assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2400 "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2401
2402 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2403 // structure.
2404 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2405 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
2406
2407 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2408 if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2409 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2410 return QualType(RT, 0);
2411
2412 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2413
2414 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2415 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2416 QualType Canonical;
2417 if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2418 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2419 Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
2420
2421 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2422 LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2423 LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2424 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2425 }
2426
2427 LValueReferenceType *New
2428 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2429 SpelledAsLValue);
2430 Types.push_back(New);
2431 LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2432
2433 return QualType(New, 0);
2434 }
2435
2436 /// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2437 /// rvalue reference to the specified type.
getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const2438 QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
2439 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2440 // structure.
2441 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2442 ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
2443
2444 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2445 if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2446 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2447 return QualType(RT, 0);
2448
2449 const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2450
2451 // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2452 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2453 QualType Canonical;
2454 if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2455 QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2456 Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
2457
2458 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2459 RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2460 RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2461 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2462 }
2463
2464 RValueReferenceType *New
2465 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
2466 Types.push_back(New);
2467 RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2468 return QualType(New, 0);
2469 }
2470
2471 /// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2472 /// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
getMemberPointerType(QualType T,const Type * Cls) const2473 QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
2474 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2475 // structure.
2476 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2477 MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2478
2479 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2480 if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2481 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2482 return QualType(PT, 0);
2483
2484 // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2485 // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2486 QualType Canonical;
2487 if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2488 Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2489
2490 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2491 MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2492 MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2493 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2494 }
2495 MemberPointerType *New
2496 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
2497 Types.push_back(New);
2498 MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2499 return QualType(New, 0);
2500 }
2501
2502 /// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
2503 /// array of the specified element type.
getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,const llvm::APInt & ArySizeIn,ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const2504 QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2505 const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
2506 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2507 unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
2508 assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2509 EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
2510 "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2511
2512 // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2513 // the target.
2514 llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
2515 ArySize =
2516 ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
2517
2518 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2519 ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
2520
2521 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2522 if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
2523 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2524 return QualType(ATP, 0);
2525
2526 // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2527 // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2528 QualType Canon;
2529 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2530 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
2531 Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
2532 ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
2533 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
2534
2535 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2536 ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
2537 ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2538 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2539 }
2540
2541 ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
2542 ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
2543 ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2544 Types.push_back(New);
2545 return QualType(New, 0);
2546 }
2547
2548 /// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2549 /// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2550 /// sizes replaced with [*].
getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const2551 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2552 // Vastly most common case.
2553 if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
2554
2555 QualType result;
2556
2557 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
2558 const Type *ty = split.Ty;
2559 switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2560 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
2561 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2562 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2563 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2564 llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2565
2566 // These types should never be variably-modified.
2567 case Type::Builtin:
2568 case Type::Complex:
2569 case Type::Vector:
2570 case Type::ExtVector:
2571 case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2572 case Type::ObjCObject:
2573 case Type::ObjCInterface:
2574 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2575 case Type::Record:
2576 case Type::Enum:
2577 case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2578 case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2579 case Type::TypeOf:
2580 case Type::Decltype:
2581 case Type::UnaryTransform:
2582 case Type::DependentName:
2583 case Type::InjectedClassName:
2584 case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2585 case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2586 case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2587 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
2588 case Type::Auto:
2589 case Type::PackExpansion:
2590 llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2591
2592 // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2593 // further decay.
2594 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2595 case Type::FunctionProto:
2596 case Type::BlockPointer:
2597 case Type::MemberPointer:
2598 return type;
2599
2600 // These types can be variably-modified. All these modifications
2601 // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2602 // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2603 // optimizations available here.
2604 case Type::Pointer:
2605 result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2606 cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2607 break;
2608
2609 case Type::LValueReference: {
2610 const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2611 result = getLValueReferenceType(
2612 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2613 lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2614 break;
2615 }
2616
2617 case Type::RValueReference: {
2618 const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2619 result = getRValueReferenceType(
2620 getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2621 break;
2622 }
2623
2624 case Type::Atomic: {
2625 const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2626 result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2627 break;
2628 }
2629
2630 case Type::ConstantArray: {
2631 const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2632 result = getConstantArrayType(
2633 getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2634 cat->getSize(),
2635 cat->getSizeModifier(),
2636 cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2637 break;
2638 }
2639
2640 case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2641 const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2642 result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2643 getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2644 dat->getSizeExpr(),
2645 dat->getSizeModifier(),
2646 dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2647 dat->getBracketsRange());
2648 break;
2649 }
2650
2651 // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2652 case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2653 const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2654 result = getVariableArrayType(
2655 getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
2656 /*size*/ nullptr,
2657 ArrayType::Normal,
2658 iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2659 SourceRange());
2660 break;
2661 }
2662
2663 // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2664 case Type::VariableArray: {
2665 const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2666 result = getVariableArrayType(
2667 getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
2668 /*size*/ nullptr,
2669 ArrayType::Star,
2670 vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2671 vat->getBracketsRange());
2672 break;
2673 }
2674 }
2675
2676 // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
2677 return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
2678 }
2679
2680 /// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2681 /// variable array of the specified element type.
getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,Expr * NumElts,ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,unsigned IndexTypeQuals,SourceRange Brackets) const2682 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2683 Expr *NumElts,
2684 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2685 unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
2686 SourceRange Brackets) const {
2687 // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2688 // that have an expression provided for their size.
2689 QualType Canon;
2690
2691 // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2692 if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2693 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
2694 Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
2695 IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
2696 Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
2697 }
2698
2699 VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
2700 VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
2701
2702 VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2703 Types.push_back(New);
2704 return QualType(New, 0);
2705 }
2706
2707 /// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2708 /// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
2709 /// type.
getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,Expr * numElements,ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,unsigned elementTypeQuals,SourceRange brackets) const2710 QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2711 Expr *numElements,
2712 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2713 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2714 SourceRange brackets) const {
2715 assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2716 numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
2717 "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2718
2719 // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2720 // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2721 // initializer. We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2722 // because they can't be used in most locations.
2723 if (!numElements) {
2724 DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2725 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2726 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2727 numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2728 brackets);
2729 Types.push_back(newType);
2730 return QualType(newType, 0);
2731 }
2732
2733 // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2734 // also build a canonical type.
2735
2736 SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2737
2738 void *insertPos = nullptr;
2739 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2740 DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
2741 QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
2742 ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
2743
2744 // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2745 DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2746 DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2747
2748 // If we don't have one, build one.
2749 if (!canonTy) {
2750 canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2751 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
2752 QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2753 brackets);
2754 DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2755 Types.push_back(canonTy);
2756 }
2757
2758 // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2759 QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
2760 canonElementType.Quals);
2761
2762 // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2763 // then just use that as our result.
2764 if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
2765 return canon;
2766
2767 // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2768 // of the element type.
2769 DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2770 = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2771 DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2772 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2773 Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2774 return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
2775 }
2776
getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,unsigned elementTypeQuals) const2777 QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
2778 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2779 unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
2780 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2781 IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
2782
2783 void *insertPos = nullptr;
2784 if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2785 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2786 return QualType(iat, 0);
2787
2788 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2789 // either, so fill in the canonical type field. We also have to pull
2790 // qualifiers off the element type.
2791 QualType canon;
2792
2793 if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2794 SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2795 canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
2796 ASM, elementTypeQuals);
2797 canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
2798
2799 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2800 IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2801 IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2802 assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
2803 }
2804
2805 IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2806 IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
2807
2808 IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2809 Types.push_back(newType);
2810 return QualType(newType, 0);
2811 }
2812
2813 /// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2814 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
getVectorType(QualType vecType,unsigned NumElts,VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const2815 QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
2816 VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
2817 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
2818
2819 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2820 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2821 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
2822
2823 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2824 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2825 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2826
2827 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2828 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2829 QualType Canonical;
2830 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
2831 Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
2832
2833 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2834 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2835 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2836 }
2837 VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2838 VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
2839 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2840 Types.push_back(New);
2841 return QualType(New, 0);
2842 }
2843
2844 /// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
2845 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
2846 QualType
getExtVectorType(QualType vecType,unsigned NumElts) const2847 ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
2848 assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
2849
2850 // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2851 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2852 VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
2853 VectorType::GenericVector);
2854 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2855 if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2856 return QualType(VTP, 0);
2857
2858 // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2859 // so fill in the canonical type field.
2860 QualType Canonical;
2861 if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
2862 Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
2863
2864 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2865 VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2866 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2867 }
2868 ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2869 ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
2870 VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2871 Types.push_back(New);
2872 return QualType(New, 0);
2873 }
2874
2875 QualType
getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,Expr * SizeExpr,SourceLocation AttrLoc) const2876 ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2877 Expr *SizeExpr,
2878 SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
2879 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2880 DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
2881 SizeExpr);
2882
2883 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2884 DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2885 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2886 DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2887 if (Canon) {
2888 // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2889 // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
2890 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2891 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2892 SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
2893 } else {
2894 QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2895 if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
2896 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2897 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2898 AttrLoc);
2899
2900 DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2901 = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2902 assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2903 (void)CanonCheck;
2904 DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2905 } else {
2906 QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2907 SourceLocation());
2908 New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2909 DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
2910 }
2911 }
2912
2913 Types.push_back(New);
2914 return QualType(New, 0);
2915 }
2916
2917 /// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
2918 ///
2919 QualType
getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,const FunctionType::ExtInfo & Info) const2920 ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2921 const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
2922 const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2923
2924 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2925 // structure.
2926 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2927 FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
2928
2929 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2930 if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
2931 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2932 return QualType(FT, 0);
2933
2934 QualType Canonical;
2935 if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2936 Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
2937
2938 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2939 FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2940 FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2941 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2942 }
2943
2944 FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
2945 FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2946 FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
2947 Types.push_back(New);
2948 FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2949 return QualType(New, 0);
2950 }
2951
2952 /// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
isCanonicalResultType(QualType T)2953 static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2954 return T.isCanonical() &&
2955 (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2956 T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2957 }
2958
2959 QualType
getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy,ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo & EPI) const2960 ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
2961 const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
2962 size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2963
2964 // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2965 // structure.
2966 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2967 FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2968 *this);
2969
2970 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2971 if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
2972 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2973 return QualType(FTP, 0);
2974
2975 // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
2976 bool isCanonical =
2977 EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
2978 !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
2979 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
2980 if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
2981 isCanonical = false;
2982
2983 // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
2984 // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
2985 QualType Canonical;
2986 if (!isCanonical) {
2987 SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
2988 CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2989 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
2990 CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
2991
2992 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
2993 CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
2994 CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
2995
2996 // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2997 QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2998 if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2999 Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
3000 Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
3001 CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
3002 }
3003
3004 Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
3005
3006 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3007 FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
3008 FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3009 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3010 }
3011
3012 // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
3013 // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
3014 // - parameter types
3015 // - exception types
3016 // - consumed-arguments flags
3017 // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
3018 // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
3019 // specification.
3020 size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
3021 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
3022 if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
3023 Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3024 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
3025 Size += sizeof(Expr*);
3026 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
3027 Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
3028 } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
3029 Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
3030 }
3031 if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
3032 Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
3033
3034 FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3035 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
3036 new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
3037 Types.push_back(FTP);
3038 FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
3039 return QualType(FTP, 0);
3040 }
3041
3042 #ifndef NDEBUG
NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl * D)3043 static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3044 if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3045 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3046 if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3047 return true;
3048 if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3049 !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3050 return true;
3051 return false;
3052 }
3053 #endif
3054
3055 /// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3056 /// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl * Decl,QualType TST) const3057 QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
3058 QualType TST) const {
3059 assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3060 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3061 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3062 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
3063 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3064 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3065 assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3066 } else {
3067 Type *newType =
3068 new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
3069 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3070 Types.push_back(newType);
3071 }
3072 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3073 }
3074
3075 /// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3076 /// specified type declaration.
getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl * Decl) const3077 QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
3078 assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
3079 assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
3080
3081 if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
3082 return getTypedefType(Typedef);
3083
3084 assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3085 "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3086
3087 if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
3088 assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
3089 assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
3090 return getRecordType(Record);
3091 } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
3092 assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
3093 return getEnumType(Enum);
3094 } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
3095 dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
3096 Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3097 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3098 Types.push_back(newType);
3099 } else
3100 llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
3101
3102 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3103 }
3104
3105 /// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3106 /// specified typedef name decl.
3107 QualType
getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl * Decl,QualType Canonical) const3108 ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3109 QualType Canonical) const {
3110 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3111
3112 if (Canonical.isNull())
3113 Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
3114 TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
3115 TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
3116 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3117 Types.push_back(newType);
3118 return QualType(newType, 0);
3119 }
3120
getRecordType(const RecordDecl * Decl) const3121 QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
3122 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3123
3124 if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
3125 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3126 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3127
3128 RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3129 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3130 Types.push_back(newType);
3131 return QualType(newType, 0);
3132 }
3133
getEnumType(const EnumDecl * Decl) const3134 QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
3135 if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3136
3137 if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
3138 if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3139 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3140
3141 EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3142 Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3143 Types.push_back(newType);
3144 return QualType(newType, 0);
3145 }
3146
getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,QualType modifiedType,QualType equivalentType)3147 QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3148 QualType modifiedType,
3149 QualType equivalentType) {
3150 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3151 AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3152
3153 void *insertPos = nullptr;
3154 AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3155 if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3156
3157 QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3158 type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3159 AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3160
3161 Types.push_back(type);
3162 AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3163
3164 return QualType(type, 0);
3165 }
3166
3167
3168 /// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3169 QualType
getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType * Parm,QualType Replacement) const3170 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3171 QualType Replacement) const {
3172 assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
3173 && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3174
3175 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3176 SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
3177 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3178 SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3179 = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3180
3181 if (!SubstParm) {
3182 SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3183 SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3184 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3185 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3186 }
3187
3188 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3189 }
3190
3191 /// \brief Retrieve a
getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(const TemplateTypeParmType * Parm,const TemplateArgument & ArgPack)3192 QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3193 const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3194 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3195 #ifndef NDEBUG
3196 for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3197 assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3198 assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
3199 }
3200 #endif
3201
3202 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3203 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
3204 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3205 if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3206 = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3207 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3208
3209 QualType Canon;
3210 if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3211 Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3212 Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3213 ArgPack);
3214 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3215 }
3216
3217 SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3218 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3219 ArgPack);
3220 Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3221 SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3222 return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3223 }
3224
3225 /// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
3226 /// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
3227 /// name.
getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth,unsigned Index,bool ParameterPack,TemplateTypeParmDecl * TTPDecl) const3228 QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
3229 bool ParameterPack,
3230 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
3231 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3232 TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
3233 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3234 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
3235 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3236
3237 if (TypeParm)
3238 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3239
3240 if (TTPDecl) {
3241 QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
3242 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
3243
3244 TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3245 = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3246 assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3247 (void)TypeCheck;
3248 } else
3249 TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3250 TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
3251
3252 Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3253 TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3254
3255 return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3256 }
3257
3258 TypeSourceInfo *
getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,SourceLocation NameLoc,const TemplateArgumentListInfo & Args,QualType Underlying) const3259 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3260 SourceLocation NameLoc,
3261 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
3262 QualType Underlying) const {
3263 assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3264 "No dependent template names here!");
3265 QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
3266
3267 TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
3268 TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3269 DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
3270 TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
3271 TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3272 TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3273 TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3274 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3275 TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3276 return DI;
3277 }
3278
3279 QualType
getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,const TemplateArgumentListInfo & Args,QualType Underlying) const3280 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3281 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
3282 QualType Underlying) const {
3283 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3284 "No dependent template names here!");
3285
3286 unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3287
3288 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
3289 ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3290 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3291 ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3292
3293 return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
3294 Underlying);
3295 }
3296
3297 #ifndef NDEBUG
hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument * Args,unsigned NumArgs)3298 static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3299 unsigned NumArgs) {
3300 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3301 if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3302 return true;
3303
3304 return true;
3305 }
3306 #endif
3307
3308 QualType
getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,const TemplateArgument * Args,unsigned NumArgs,QualType Underlying) const3309 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3310 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3311 unsigned NumArgs,
3312 QualType Underlying) const {
3313 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3314 "No dependent template names here!");
3315 // Look through qualified template names.
3316 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3317 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
3318
3319 bool IsTypeAlias =
3320 Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3321 isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
3322 QualType CanonType;
3323 if (!Underlying.isNull())
3324 CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3325 else {
3326 // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3327 // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3328 assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3329 "Caller must compute aliased type");
3330 IsTypeAlias = false;
3331 CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3332 NumArgs);
3333 }
3334
3335 // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3336 // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3337 // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
3338 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3339 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
3340 (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
3341 TypeAlignment);
3342 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3343 = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3344 IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
3345
3346 Types.push_back(Spec);
3347 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3348 }
3349
3350 QualType
getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,const TemplateArgument * Args,unsigned NumArgs) const3351 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3352 const TemplateArgument *Args,
3353 unsigned NumArgs) const {
3354 assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3355 "No dependent template names here!");
3356
3357 // Look through qualified template names.
3358 if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3359 Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
3360
3361 // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3362 TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
3363 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
3364 CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3365 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3366 CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3367
3368 // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3369 // exists.
3370 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3371 TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3372 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3373
3374 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3375 TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3376 = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3377
3378 if (!Spec) {
3379 // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3380 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3381 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3382 TypeAlignment);
3383 Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3384 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
3385 QualType(), QualType());
3386 Types.push_back(Spec);
3387 TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3388 }
3389
3390 assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3391 "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3392 return QualType(Spec, 0);
3393 }
3394
3395 QualType
getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,QualType NamedType) const3396 ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3397 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3398 QualType NamedType) const {
3399 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3400 ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
3401
3402 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3403 ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3404 if (T)
3405 return QualType(T, 0);
3406
3407 QualType Canon = NamedType;
3408 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3409 Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
3410 ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3411 assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
3412 (void)CheckT;
3413 }
3414
3415 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
3416 Types.push_back(T);
3417 ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3418 return QualType(T, 0);
3419 }
3420
3421 QualType
getParenType(QualType InnerType) const3422 ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
3423 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3424 ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3425
3426 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3427 ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3428 if (T)
3429 return QualType(T, 0);
3430
3431 QualType Canon = InnerType;
3432 if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3433 Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3434 ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3435 assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3436 (void)CheckT;
3437 }
3438
3439 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3440 Types.push_back(T);
3441 ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3442 return QualType(T, 0);
3443 }
3444
getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,const IdentifierInfo * Name,QualType Canon) const3445 QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3446 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3447 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3448 QualType Canon) const {
3449 if (Canon.isNull()) {
3450 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
3451 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3452 if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3453 CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3454
3455 if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3456 Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
3457 }
3458
3459 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3460 DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
3461
3462 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3463 DependentNameType *T
3464 = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3465 if (T)
3466 return QualType(T, 0);
3467
3468 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
3469 Types.push_back(T);
3470 DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3471 return QualType(T, 0);
3472 }
3473
3474 QualType
getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,const IdentifierInfo * Name,const TemplateArgumentListInfo & Args) const3475 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3476 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3477 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3478 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3479 const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
3480 // TODO: avoid this copy
3481 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
3482 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3483 ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3484 return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3485 ArgCopy.size(),
3486 ArgCopy.data());
3487 }
3488
3489 QualType
getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,const IdentifierInfo * Name,unsigned NumArgs,const TemplateArgument * Args) const3490 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3491 ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3492 NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3493 const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3494 unsigned NumArgs,
3495 const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
3496 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3497 "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
3498
3499 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3500 DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3501 Name, NumArgs, Args);
3502
3503 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3504 DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3505 = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3506 if (T)
3507 return QualType(T, 0);
3508
3509 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
3510
3511 ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3512 if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3513
3514 bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
3515 SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
3516 for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3517 CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3518 if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3519 AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
3520 }
3521
3522 QualType Canon;
3523 if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3524 Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3525 Name, NumArgs,
3526 CanonArgs.data());
3527
3528 // Find the insert position again.
3529 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3530 }
3531
3532 void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3533 sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3534 TypeAlignment);
3535 T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
3536 Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
3537 Types.push_back(T);
3538 DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3539 return QualType(T, 0);
3540 }
3541
getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions)3542 QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
3543 Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
3544 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3545 PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
3546
3547 assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3548 "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
3549 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3550 PackExpansionType *T
3551 = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3552 if (T)
3553 return QualType(T, 0);
3554
3555 QualType Canon;
3556 if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
3557 Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3558 // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3559 // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3560 // parameters.
3561 if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
3562 Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
3563
3564 // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3565 // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3566 PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3567 }
3568 }
3569
3570 T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3571 PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
3572 Types.push_back(T);
3573 PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3574 return QualType(T, 0);
3575 }
3576
3577 /// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3578 /// alphabetically.
CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl * const * LHS,ObjCProtocolDecl * const * RHS)3579 static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
3580 ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
3581 return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
3582 }
3583
areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const * Protocols,unsigned NumProtocols)3584 static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
3585 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3586 if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3587
3588 if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3589 return false;
3590
3591 for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
3592 if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
3593 Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
3594 return false;
3595 return true;
3596 }
3597
SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl ** Protocols,unsigned & NumProtocols)3598 static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
3599 unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3600 ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
3601
3602 // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3603 llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd, CmpProtocolNames);
3604
3605 // Canonicalize.
3606 for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3607 Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3608
3609 // Remove duplicates.
3610 ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3611 NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3612 }
3613
getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,ObjCProtocolDecl * const * Protocols,unsigned NumProtocols) const3614 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3615 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
3616 unsigned NumProtocols) const {
3617 return getObjCObjectType(BaseType, { },
3618 llvm::makeArrayRef(Protocols, NumProtocols),
3619 /*isKindOf=*/false);
3620 }
3621
getObjCObjectType(QualType baseType,ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl * > protocols,bool isKindOf) const3622 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(
3623 QualType baseType,
3624 ArrayRef<QualType> typeArgs,
3625 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> protocols,
3626 bool isKindOf) const {
3627 // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols or
3628 // type arguments to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3629 if (typeArgs.empty() && protocols.empty() && !isKindOf &&
3630 isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(baseType))
3631 return baseType;
3632
3633 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
3634 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3635 ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, baseType, typeArgs, protocols, isKindOf);
3636 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3637 if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3638 return QualType(QT, 0);
3639
3640 // Determine the type arguments to be used for canonicalization,
3641 // which may be explicitly specified here or written on the base
3642 // type.
3643 ArrayRef<QualType> effectiveTypeArgs = typeArgs;
3644 if (effectiveTypeArgs.empty()) {
3645 if (auto baseObject = baseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>())
3646 effectiveTypeArgs = baseObject->getTypeArgs();
3647 }
3648
3649 // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and a
3650 // sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols and the type arguments
3651 // canonicalized.
3652 QualType canonical;
3653 bool typeArgsAreCanonical = std::all_of(effectiveTypeArgs.begin(),
3654 effectiveTypeArgs.end(),
3655 [&](QualType type) {
3656 return type.isCanonical();
3657 });
3658 bool protocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(protocols.data(),
3659 protocols.size());
3660 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical || !protocolsSorted || !baseType.isCanonical()) {
3661 // Determine the canonical type arguments.
3662 ArrayRef<QualType> canonTypeArgs;
3663 SmallVector<QualType, 4> canonTypeArgsVec;
3664 if (!typeArgsAreCanonical) {
3665 canonTypeArgsVec.reserve(effectiveTypeArgs.size());
3666 for (auto typeArg : effectiveTypeArgs)
3667 canonTypeArgsVec.push_back(getCanonicalType(typeArg));
3668 canonTypeArgs = canonTypeArgsVec;
3669 } else {
3670 canonTypeArgs = effectiveTypeArgs;
3671 }
3672
3673 ArrayRef<ObjCProtocolDecl *> canonProtocols;
3674 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> canonProtocolsVec;
3675 if (!protocolsSorted) {
3676 canonProtocolsVec.insert(canonProtocolsVec.begin(),
3677 protocols.begin(),
3678 protocols.end());
3679 unsigned uniqueCount = protocols.size();
3680 SortAndUniqueProtocols(&canonProtocolsVec[0], uniqueCount);
3681 canonProtocols = llvm::makeArrayRef(&canonProtocolsVec[0], uniqueCount);
3682 } else {
3683 canonProtocols = protocols;
3684 }
3685
3686 canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(baseType), canonTypeArgs,
3687 canonProtocols, isKindOf);
3688
3689 // Regenerate InsertPos.
3690 ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3691 }
3692
3693 unsigned size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3694 size += typeArgs.size() * sizeof(QualType);
3695 size += protocols.size() * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3696 void *mem = Allocate(size, TypeAlignment);
3697 ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3698 new (mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(canonical, baseType, typeArgs, protocols,
3699 isKindOf);
3700
3701 Types.push_back(T);
3702 ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3703 return QualType(T, 0);
3704 }
3705
3706 /// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3707 /// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3708 /// list.
ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,ObjCInterfaceDecl * IC)3709 bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3710 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3711 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3712 return false;
3713
3714 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3715 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3716 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3717 if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3718 return false;
3719 }
3720 return true;
3721 }
3722 return false;
3723 }
3724
3725 /// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3726 /// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3727 /// of protocols.
QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,ObjCInterfaceDecl * IDecl)3728 bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3729 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3730 if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3731 return false;
3732 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3733 if (!OPT)
3734 return false;
3735 if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3736 return false;
3737 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3738 CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3739 if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3740 return false;
3741 // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3742 // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3743 bool Conforms = false;
3744 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3745 Conforms = false;
3746 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3747 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3748 Conforms = true;
3749 break;
3750 }
3751 }
3752 if (!Conforms)
3753 break;
3754 }
3755 if (Conforms)
3756 return true;
3757
3758 for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3759 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3760 bool Adopts = false;
3761 for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3762 // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
3763 if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
3764 break;
3765 }
3766 if (!Adopts)
3767 return false;
3768 }
3769 return true;
3770 }
3771
3772 /// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3773 /// the given object type.
getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const3774 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
3775 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3776 ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3777
3778 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3779 if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3780 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3781 return QualType(QT, 0);
3782
3783 // Find the canonical object type.
3784 QualType Canonical;
3785 if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3786 Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3787
3788 // Regenerate InsertPos.
3789 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3790 }
3791
3792 // No match.
3793 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3794 ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3795 new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
3796
3797 Types.push_back(QType);
3798 ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
3799 return QualType(QType, 0);
3800 }
3801
3802 /// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3803 /// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl * Decl,ObjCInterfaceDecl * PrevDecl) const3804 QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3805 ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
3806 if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3807 return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3808
3809 if (PrevDecl) {
3810 assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3811 Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3812 return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3813 }
3814
3815 // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3816 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3817 Decl = Def;
3818
3819 void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3820 ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3821 Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3822 Types.push_back(T);
3823 return QualType(T, 0);
3824 }
3825
3826 /// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3827 /// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
3828 /// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
3829 /// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
3830 /// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
getTypeOfExprType(Expr * tofExpr) const3831 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
3832 TypeOfExprType *toe;
3833 if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3834 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3835 DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
3836
3837 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3838 DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3839 = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3840 if (Canon) {
3841 // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3842 // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
3843 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
3844 QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
3845 } else {
3846 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
3847 Canon
3848 = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
3849 DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3850 toe = Canon;
3851 }
3852 } else {
3853 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
3854 toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
3855 }
3856 Types.push_back(toe);
3857 return QualType(toe, 0);
3858 }
3859
3860 /// getTypeOfType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3861 /// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3862 /// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
3863 /// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3864 /// on canonical types (which are always unique).
getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const3865 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
3866 QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
3867 TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
3868 Types.push_back(tot);
3869 return QualType(tot, 0);
3870 }
3871
3872
3873 /// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3874 /// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3875 /// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3876 /// is an Expr tree under each such type.
getDecltypeType(Expr * e,QualType UnderlyingType) const3877 QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
3878 DecltypeType *dt;
3879
3880 // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
3881 // If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
3882 // unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3883 // type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
3884 if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
3885 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3886 DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
3887
3888 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3889 DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3890 = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3891 if (!Canon) {
3892 // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
3893 Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
3894 DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3895 }
3896 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3897 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
3898 } else {
3899 dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3900 DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
3901 }
3902 Types.push_back(dt);
3903 return QualType(dt, 0);
3904 }
3905
3906 /// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3907 /// savings are minimal and these are rare.
getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,QualType UnderlyingType,UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind) const3908 QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3909 QualType UnderlyingType,
3910 UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3911 const {
3912 UnaryTransformType *Ty =
3913 new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3914 Kind,
3915 UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
3916 QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
3917 Types.push_back(Ty);
3918 return QualType(Ty, 0);
3919 }
3920
3921 /// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3922 /// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3923 /// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
getAutoType(QualType DeducedType,bool IsDecltypeAuto,bool IsDependent) const3924 QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
3925 bool IsDependent) const {
3926 if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
3927 return getAutoDeductType();
3928
3929 // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
3930 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3931 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3932 AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
3933 if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3934 return QualType(AT, 0);
3935
3936 AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
3937 IsDecltypeAuto,
3938 IsDependent);
3939 Types.push_back(AT);
3940 if (InsertPos)
3941 AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3942 return QualType(AT, 0);
3943 }
3944
3945 /// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3946 /// the given value type.
getAtomicType(QualType T) const3947 QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3948 // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3949 // structure.
3950 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3951 AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3952
3953 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3954 if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3955 return QualType(AT, 0);
3956
3957 // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3958 // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3959 QualType Canonical;
3960 if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3961 Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3962
3963 // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3964 AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3965 assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3966 }
3967 AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3968 Types.push_back(New);
3969 AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3970 return QualType(New, 0);
3971 }
3972
3973 /// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
getAutoDeductType() const3974 QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3975 if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
3976 AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3977 new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
3978 /*dependent*/false),
3979 0);
3980 return AutoDeductTy;
3981 }
3982
3983 /// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
getAutoRRefDeductType() const3984 QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3985 if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3986 AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3987 assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3988 return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3989 }
3990
3991 /// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3992 /// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
getTagDeclType(const TagDecl * Decl) const3993 QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
3994 assert (Decl);
3995 // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3996 // away const? mutable?
3997 return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
3998 }
3999
4000 /// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
4001 /// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
4002 /// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
getSizeType() const4003 CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
4004 return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
4005 }
4006
4007 /// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
getIntMaxType() const4008 CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
4009 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
4010 }
4011
4012 /// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
getUIntMaxType() const4013 CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
4014 return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
4015 }
4016
4017 /// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
4018 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
getSignedWCharType() const4019 QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
4020 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4021 return WCharTy;
4022 }
4023
4024 /// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
4025 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
getUnsignedWCharType() const4026 QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
4027 // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
4028 return UnsignedIntTy;
4029 }
4030
getIntPtrType() const4031 QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
4032 return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
4033 }
4034
getUIntPtrType() const4035 QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
4036 return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
4037 }
4038
4039 /// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
4040 /// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
getPointerDiffType() const4041 QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
4042 return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
4043 }
4044
4045 /// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
4046 /// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
getProcessIDType() const4047 QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
4048 return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
4049 }
4050
4051 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4052 // Type Operators
4053 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4054
getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const4055 CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
4056 // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
4057 // qualifiers.
4058 T = getCanonicalType(T);
4059 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4060 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
4061 QualType Result;
4062 if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
4063 Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
4064 } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
4065 Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
4066 } else {
4067 Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
4068 }
4069
4070 return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
4071 }
4072
getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,Qualifiers & quals)4073 QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
4074 Qualifiers &quals) {
4075 SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
4076
4077 // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
4078 // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
4079 // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
4080 // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
4081 const ArrayType *AT =
4082 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
4083
4084 // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
4085 if (!AT) {
4086 quals = splitType.Quals;
4087 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
4088 }
4089
4090 // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4091 QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4092 QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4093
4094 // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4095 // can just use the results in splitType.
4096 if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4097 assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
4098 quals = splitType.Quals;
4099 return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
4100 }
4101
4102 // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4103 // build the type back up.
4104 quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
4105
4106 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
4107 return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
4108 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4109 }
4110
4111 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
4112 return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4113 }
4114
4115 if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
4116 return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
4117 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
4118 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4119 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4120 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4121 }
4122
4123 const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
4124 return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
4125 DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4126 SourceRange());
4127 }
4128
4129 /// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types that
4130 /// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4131 /// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4132 /// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4133 /// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4134 /// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4135 /// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4136 /// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType & T1,QualType & T2)4137 bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4138 const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4139 *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4140 if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4141 T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4142 T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4143 return true;
4144 }
4145
4146 const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4147 *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4148 if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4149 hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4150 QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4151 T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4152 T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4153 return true;
4154 }
4155
4156 if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
4157 const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4158 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4159 if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4160 T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4161 T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4162 return true;
4163 }
4164 }
4165
4166 // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4167
4168 return false;
4169 }
4170
4171 DeclarationNameInfo
getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,SourceLocation NameLoc) const4172 ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4173 SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
4174 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4175 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4176 case TemplateName::Template:
4177 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4178 return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4179 NameLoc);
4180
4181 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4182 OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4183 // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4184 return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4185 }
4186
4187 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4188 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4189 DeclarationName DName;
4190 if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
4191 DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4192 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
4193 } else {
4194 DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4195 // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4196 DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4197 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4198 DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4199 return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
4200 }
4201 }
4202
4203 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4204 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4205 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4206 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4207 NameLoc);
4208 }
4209
4210 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4211 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4212 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4213 return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4214 NameLoc);
4215 }
4216 }
4217
4218 llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
4219 }
4220
getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const4221 TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
4222 switch (Name.getKind()) {
4223 case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4224 case TemplateName::Template: {
4225 TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
4226 if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
4227 = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
4228 Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4229
4230 // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
4231 return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
4232 }
4233
4234 case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4235 llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
4236
4237 case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4238 DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4239 assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4240 return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4241 }
4242
4243 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4244 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4245 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4246 return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4247 }
4248
4249 case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4250 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4251 = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4252 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4253 = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4254 TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4255 = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4256 return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4257 }
4258 }
4259
4260 llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
4261 }
4262
hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X,TemplateName Y)4263 bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4264 X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4265 Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4266 return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4267 }
4268
4269 TemplateArgument
getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument & Arg) const4270 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
4271 switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4272 case TemplateArgument::Null:
4273 return Arg;
4274
4275 case TemplateArgument::Expression:
4276 return Arg;
4277
4278 case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
4279 ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
4280 return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
4281 }
4282
4283 case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4284 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4285 /*isNullPtr*/true);
4286
4287 case TemplateArgument::Template:
4288 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
4289
4290 case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4291 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4292 Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
4293 Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
4294
4295 case TemplateArgument::Integral:
4296 return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
4297
4298 case TemplateArgument::Type:
4299 return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
4300
4301 case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
4302 if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4303 return Arg;
4304
4305 TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4306 = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
4307 unsigned Idx = 0;
4308 for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
4309 AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4310 A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4311 CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
4312
4313 return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
4314 }
4315 }
4316
4317 // Silence GCC warning
4318 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
4319 }
4320
4321 NestedNameSpecifier *
getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier * NNS) const4322 ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
4323 if (!NNS)
4324 return nullptr;
4325
4326 switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4327 case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4328 // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
4329 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
4330 getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4331 NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4332
4333 case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4334 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4335 // this namespace and no prefix.
4336 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
4337 NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4338
4339 case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4340 // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4341 // this namespace and no prefix.
4342 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
4343 NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4344 ->getOriginalNamespace());
4345
4346 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4347 case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4348 QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
4349
4350 // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4351 // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4352 // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4353 // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4354 // types, e.g.,
4355 // typedef typename T::type T1;
4356 // typedef typename T1::type T2;
4357 if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4358 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
4359 const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
4360
4361 // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4362 // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4363 // first place?
4364 return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4365 const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
4366 }
4367
4368 case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4369 case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
4370 // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
4371 return NNS;
4372 }
4373
4374 llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
4375 }
4376
4377
getAsArrayType(QualType T) const4378 const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
4379 // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
4380 if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
4381 // Handle the common positive case fast.
4382 if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4383 return AT;
4384 }
4385
4386 // Handle the common negative case fast.
4387 if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
4388 return nullptr;
4389
4390 // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type. This
4391 // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4392 // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
4393
4394 // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4395 // sugar such as a typedef in the way. If we have type qualifiers on the type
4396 // we must propagate them down into the element type.
4397
4398 SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
4399 Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
4400
4401 // If we have a simple case, just return now.
4402 const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
4403 if (!ATy || qs.empty())
4404 return ATy;
4405
4406 // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it. Push the
4407 // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
4408 QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
4409
4410 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4411 return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4412 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
4413 CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
4414 if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4415 return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4416 IAT->getSizeModifier(),
4417 IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
4418
4419 if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
4420 = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4421 return cast<ArrayType>(
4422 getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
4423 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
4424 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
4425 DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4426 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
4427
4428 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
4429 return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
4430 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
4431 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4432 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4433 VAT->getBracketsRange()));
4434 }
4435
getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const4436 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
4437 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4438 return getDecayedType(T);
4439 return T;
4440 }
4441
getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const4442 QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
4443 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4444 T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4445 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4446 }
4447
getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const4448 QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
4449 // C++ [except.throw]p3:
4450 // A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
4451 // object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
4452 // cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
4453 // the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
4454 // or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
4455 T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4456 if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4457 T = getDecayedType(T);
4458 return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4459 }
4460
4461 /// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4462 /// specified array type to a pointer. This operation is non-trivial when
4463 /// handling typedefs etc. The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4464 /// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4465 ///
4466 /// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const4467 QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
4468 // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4469 // typedefs in the element type of the array. This also handles propagation
4470 // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4471 // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4472 const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4473 assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
4474
4475 QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
4476
4477 // int x[restrict 4] -> int *restrict
4478 return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
4479 }
4480
getBaseElementType(const ArrayType * array) const4481 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4482 return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
4483 }
4484
getBaseElementType(QualType type) const4485 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4486 Qualifiers qs;
4487 while (true) {
4488 SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
4489 const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
4490 if (!array) break;
4491
4492 type = array->getElementType();
4493 qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
4494 }
4495
4496 return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
4497 }
4498
4499 /// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
4500 uint64_t
getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType * CA) const4501 ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA) const {
4502 uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4503 do {
4504 ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
4505 CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4506 CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
4507 } while (CA);
4508 return ElementCount;
4509 }
4510
4511 /// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4512 /// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
getFloatingRank(QualType T)4513 static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
4514 if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
4515 return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
4516
4517 assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4518 switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
4519 default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4520 case BuiltinType::Half: return HalfRank;
4521 case BuiltinType::Float: return FloatRank;
4522 case BuiltinType::Double: return DoubleRank;
4523 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
4524 }
4525 }
4526
4527 /// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4528 /// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
4529 /// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4530 /// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,QualType Domain) const4531 QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4532 QualType Domain) const {
4533 FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4534 if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4535 switch (EltRank) {
4536 case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
4537 case FloatRank: return FloatComplexTy;
4538 case DoubleRank: return DoubleComplexTy;
4539 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4540 }
4541 }
4542
4543 assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4544 switch (EltRank) {
4545 case HalfRank: return HalfTy;
4546 case FloatRank: return FloatTy;
4547 case DoubleRank: return DoubleTy;
4548 case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
4549 }
4550 llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
4551 }
4552
4553 /// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4554 /// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4555 /// '_Complex double'). If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
4556 /// LHS < RHS, return -1.
getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS,QualType RHS) const4557 int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
4558 FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4559 FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
4560
4561 if (LHSR == RHSR)
4562 return 0;
4563 if (LHSR > RHSR)
4564 return 1;
4565 return -1;
4566 }
4567
4568 /// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4569 /// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4570 /// or if it is not canonicalized.
getIntegerRank(const Type * T) const4571 unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
4572 assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
4573
4574 switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
4575 default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
4576 case BuiltinType::Bool:
4577 return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
4578 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4579 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4580 case BuiltinType::SChar:
4581 case BuiltinType::UChar:
4582 return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
4583 case BuiltinType::Short:
4584 case BuiltinType::UShort:
4585 return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
4586 case BuiltinType::Int:
4587 case BuiltinType::UInt:
4588 return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
4589 case BuiltinType::Long:
4590 case BuiltinType::ULong:
4591 return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
4592 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4593 case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
4594 return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
4595 case BuiltinType::Int128:
4596 case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4597 return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
4598 }
4599 }
4600
4601 /// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4602 /// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4603 ///
4604 /// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4605 /// promotion occurs.
isPromotableBitField(Expr * E) const4606 QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
4607 if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4608 return QualType();
4609
4610 // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
4611 // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
4612 // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
4613
4614 FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
4615 if (!Field)
4616 return QualType();
4617
4618 QualType FT = Field->getType();
4619
4620 uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
4621 uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4622 // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
4623 // A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
4624 // int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
4625 // can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
4626 // values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
4627 // promotion applies to it.
4628 // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
4629 // [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
4630 // If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
4631 // the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
4632 // it is converted to an unsigned int.
4633 //
4634 // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
4635 // We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
4636 if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4637 return IntTy;
4638
4639 if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4640 return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4641
4642 // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4643 // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
4644 // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
4645 // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
4646 // into their semantics in some cases).
4647 return QualType();
4648 }
4649
4650 /// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4651 /// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4652 /// integer type.
getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const4653 QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
4654 assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4655 assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
4656 if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4657 return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
4658
4659 if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4660 // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4661 // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4662 // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4663 // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4664 // unsigned long long int [...]
4665 // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4666 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4667 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4668 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4669 BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4670 bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4671 uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4672 QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4673 LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4674 for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4675 uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4676 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4677 (FromSize == ToSize &&
4678 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4679 return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4680 }
4681 llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4682 }
4683 }
4684
4685 // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
4686 if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4687 return IntTy;
4688 uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4689 uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
4690 assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4691 return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4692 }
4693
4694 /// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4695 /// type and returns its ownership.
getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const4696 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4697 while (!T.isNull()) {
4698 if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4699 return T.getObjCLifetime();
4700 if (T->isArrayType())
4701 T = getBaseElementType(T);
4702 else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4703 T = PT->getPointeeType();
4704 else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4705 T = RT->getPointeeType();
4706 else
4707 break;
4708 }
4709
4710 return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4711 }
4712
getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType * ET)4713 static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4714 // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4715 // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4716 if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4717 return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
4718 return nullptr;
4719 }
4720
4721 /// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
4722 /// C99 6.3.1.8p1. If LHS > RHS, return 1. If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
4723 /// LHS < RHS, return -1.
getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS,QualType RHS) const4724 int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
4725 const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4726 const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
4727
4728 // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4729 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4730 LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4731 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4732 RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4733
4734 if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
4735
4736 bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4737 bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4738
4739 unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4740 unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
4741
4742 if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) { // Both signed or both unsigned.
4743 if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4744 return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4745 }
4746
4747 // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4748 if (LHSUnsigned) {
4749 // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4750 if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4751 return 1;
4752
4753 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4754 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
4755 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
4756 return -1;
4757 }
4758
4759 // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4760 if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4761 return -1;
4762
4763 // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4764 // wins. Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
4765 // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
4766 return 1;
4767 }
4768
4769 // getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
getCFConstantStringType() const4770 QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
4771 if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
4772 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
4773 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
4774
4775 QualType FieldTypes[4];
4776
4777 // const int *isa;
4778 FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
4779 // int flags;
4780 FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
4781 // const char *str;
4782 FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
4783 // long length;
4784 FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4785
4786 // Create fields
4787 for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
4788 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
4789 SourceLocation(),
4790 SourceLocation(), nullptr,
4791 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4792 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
4793 /*Mutable=*/false,
4794 ICIS_NoInit);
4795 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
4796 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
4797 }
4798
4799 CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
4800 }
4801
4802 return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
4803 }
4804
getObjCSuperType() const4805 QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4806 if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
4807 RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
4808 TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4809 ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4810 }
4811 return ObjCSuperType;
4812 }
4813
setCFConstantStringType(QualType T)4814 void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
4815 const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
4816 assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4817 CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4818 }
4819
getBlockDescriptorType() const4820 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
4821 if (BlockDescriptorType)
4822 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4823
4824 RecordDecl *RD;
4825 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
4826 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4827 RD->startDefinition();
4828
4829 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4830 UnsignedLongTy,
4831 UnsignedLongTy,
4832 };
4833
4834 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
4835 "reserved",
4836 "Size"
4837 };
4838
4839 for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
4840 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4841 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
4842 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4843 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
4844 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
4845 RD->addDecl(Field);
4846 }
4847
4848 RD->completeDefinition();
4849
4850 BlockDescriptorType = RD;
4851
4852 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4853 }
4854
getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const4855 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
4856 if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4857 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4858
4859 RecordDecl *RD;
4860 // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
4861 RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4862 RD->startDefinition();
4863
4864 QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4865 UnsignedLongTy,
4866 UnsignedLongTy,
4867 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4868 getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4869 };
4870
4871 static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
4872 "reserved",
4873 "Size",
4874 "CopyFuncPtr",
4875 "DestroyFuncPtr"
4876 };
4877
4878 for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
4879 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4880 *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
4881 &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4882 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
4883 /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
4884 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
4885 RD->addDecl(Field);
4886 }
4887
4888 RD->completeDefinition();
4889
4890 BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
4891 return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4892 }
4893
4894 /// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4895 /// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4896 /// in buildByrefHelpers.
BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,const VarDecl * D)4897 bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4898 const VarDecl *D) {
4899 if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4900 const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4901 if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4902
4903 return true;
4904 }
4905
4906 if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4907
4908 Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4909
4910 // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4911 if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4912 assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4913
4914 switch (lifetime) {
4915 case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4916
4917 // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4918 case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4919 case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4920 return false;
4921
4922 // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4923 // byref routines.
4924 case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4925 // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4926 case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4927 return true;
4928 }
4929 llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4930 }
4931 return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4932 Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
4933 }
4934
getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime & LifeTime,bool & HasByrefExtendedLayout) const4935 bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4936 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4937 bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4938
4939 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4940 getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4941 return false;
4942
4943 HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
4944 if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
4945 HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4946 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4947 }
4948 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4949 LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4950 // MRR.
4951 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4952 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4953 else
4954 LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4955 return true;
4956 }
4957
getObjCInstanceTypeDecl()4958 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4959 if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
4960 ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
4961 buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
4962 return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4963 }
4964
4965 // This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4966 // typedef <type> BOOL;
isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T)4967 static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
4968 if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
4969 if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4970 return II->isStr("BOOL");
4971
4972 return false;
4973 }
4974
4975 /// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
4976 /// purpose.
getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const4977 CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
4978 if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4979 return CharUnits::Zero();
4980
4981 CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
4982
4983 // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
4984 if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
4985 sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
4986 // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4987 else if (type->isArrayType())
4988 sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4989 return sz;
4990 }
4991
isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl * VD) const4992 bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
4993 return getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
4994 VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
4995 VD->isFirstDecl() && !VD->isOutOfLine() && VD->hasInit();
4996 }
4997
4998 static inline
charUnitsToString(const CharUnits & CU)4999 std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
5000 return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
5001 }
5002
5003 /// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
5004 /// declaration.
getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr * Expr) const5005 std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
5006 std::string S;
5007
5008 const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
5009 QualType BlockTy =
5010 Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5011 // Encode result type.
5012 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
5013 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
5014 Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
5015 true /*Extended*/);
5016 else
5017 getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
5018 // Compute size of all parameters.
5019 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5020 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5021 SourceLocation Loc;
5022 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5023 CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
5024 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
5025 QualType PType = PI->getType();
5026 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5027 if (sz.isZero())
5028 continue;
5029 assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
5030 ParmOffset += sz;
5031 }
5032 // Size of the argument frame
5033 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5034 // Block pointer and offset.
5035 S += "@?0";
5036
5037 // Argument types.
5038 ParmOffset = PtrSize;
5039 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
5040 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5041 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5042 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5043 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5044 // elements.
5045 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5046 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5047 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5048 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5049 if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
5050 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
5051 S, true /*Extended*/);
5052 else
5053 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5054 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5055 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5056 }
5057
5058 return S;
5059 }
5060
getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl * Decl,std::string & S)5061 bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
5062 std::string& S) {
5063 // Encode result type.
5064 getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
5065 CharUnits ParmOffset;
5066 // Compute size of all parameters.
5067 for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
5068 QualType PType = PI->getType();
5069 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5070 if (sz.isZero())
5071 continue;
5072
5073 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5074 "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
5075 ParmOffset += sz;
5076 }
5077 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5078 ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
5079
5080 // Argument types.
5081 for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
5082 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5083 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5084 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5085 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5086 // elements.
5087 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5088 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5089 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5090 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5091 getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5092 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5093 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5094 }
5095
5096 return false;
5097 }
5098
5099 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5100 /// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5101 /// block object types.
getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,QualType T,std::string & S,bool Extended) const5102 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5103 QualType T, std::string& S,
5104 bool Extended) const {
5105 // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5106 getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5107 // Encode parameter type.
5108 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5109 true /*OutermostType*/,
5110 false /*EncodingProperty*/,
5111 false /*StructField*/,
5112 Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5113 Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5114 }
5115
5116 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
5117 /// declaration.
getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl * Decl,std::string & S,bool Extended) const5118 bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
5119 std::string& S,
5120 bool Extended) const {
5121 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5122 // Encode return type.
5123 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5124 Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
5125 // Compute size of all parameters.
5126 // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5127 // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5128 SourceLocation Loc;
5129 CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5130 // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
5131 // their size.
5132 CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
5133 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
5134 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
5135 QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
5136 CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5137 if (sz.isZero())
5138 continue;
5139
5140 assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5141 "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
5142 ParmOffset += sz;
5143 }
5144 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5145 S += "@0:";
5146 S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
5147
5148 // Argument types.
5149 ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
5150 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
5151 E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
5152 const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
5153 QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5154 if (const ArrayType *AT =
5155 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5156 // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5157 // elements.
5158 if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5159 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5160 } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5161 PType = PVDecl->getType();
5162 getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5163 PType, S, Extended);
5164 S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5165 ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5166 }
5167
5168 return false;
5169 }
5170
5171 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl * PD,const Decl * Container) const5172 ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
5173 const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5174 const Decl *Container) const {
5175 if (!Container)
5176 return nullptr;
5177 if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
5178 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
5179 for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
5180 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5181 return PID;
5182 } else {
5183 const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
5184 for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
5185 if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5186 return PID;
5187 }
5188 return nullptr;
5189 }
5190
5191 /// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
5192 /// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
5193 /// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
5194 /// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
5195 /// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
5196 /// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
5197 /// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
5198 /// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
5199 /// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
5200 /// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
5201 /// @code
5202 /// enum PropertyAttributes {
5203 /// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R', // property is read-only.
5204 /// kPropertyBycopy = 'C', // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5205 /// kPropertyByref = '&', // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5206 /// kPropertyDynamic = 'D', // property is dynamic
5207 /// kPropertyGetter = 'G', // followed by getter selector name
5208 /// kPropertySetter = 'S', // followed by setter selector name
5209 /// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V' // followed by instance variable name
5210 /// kPropertyType = 'T' // followed by old-style type encoding.
5211 /// kPropertyWeak = 'W' // 'weak' property
5212 /// kPropertyStrong = 'P' // property GC'able
5213 /// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N' // property non-atomic
5214 /// };
5215 /// @endcode
getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl * PD,const Decl * Container,std::string & S) const5216 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5217 const Decl *Container,
5218 std::string& S) const {
5219 // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5220 bool Dynamic = false;
5221 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
5222
5223 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5224 getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5225 if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5226 Dynamic = true;
5227 else
5228 SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
5229 }
5230
5231 // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5232 S = "T";
5233
5234 // Encode result type.
5235 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5236 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5237 getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
5238
5239 if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5240 S += ",R";
5241 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5242 S += ",C";
5243 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5244 S += ",&";
5245 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5246 S += ",W";
5247 } else {
5248 switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5249 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5250 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy: S += ",C"; break;
5251 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
5252 case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak: S += ",W"; break;
5253 }
5254 }
5255
5256 // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5257 // are "dynamic by default".
5258 if (Dynamic)
5259 S += ",D";
5260
5261 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5262 S += ",N";
5263
5264 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5265 S += ",G";
5266 S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
5267 }
5268
5269 if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5270 S += ",S";
5271 S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
5272 }
5273
5274 if (SynthesizePID) {
5275 const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5276 S += ",V";
5277 S += OID->getNameAsString();
5278 }
5279
5280 // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5281 }
5282
5283 /// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
5284 /// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5285 /// 'l' or 'L' , but not always. For typedefs, we need to use
5286 /// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5287 ///
getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(QualType & PointeeTy) const5288 void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
5289 if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
5290 if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5291 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
5292 PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
5293 else
5294 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
5295 PointeeTy = IntTy;
5296 }
5297 }
5298 }
5299
getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T,std::string & S,const FieldDecl * Field,QualType * NotEncodedT) const5300 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
5301 const FieldDecl *Field,
5302 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
5303 // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5304 // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5305 // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5306 // same type.
5307 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
5308 true /* outermost type */, false, false,
5309 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
5310 }
5311
getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,std::string & S) const5312 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5313 std::string& S) const {
5314 // Encode result type.
5315 // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5316 // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5317 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5318 true /* outermost type */,
5319 true /* encoding property */);
5320 }
5321
getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext * C,BuiltinType::Kind kind)5322 static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5323 BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5324 switch (kind) {
5325 case BuiltinType::Void: return 'v';
5326 case BuiltinType::Bool: return 'B';
5327 case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5328 case BuiltinType::UChar: return 'C';
5329 case BuiltinType::Char16:
5330 case BuiltinType::UShort: return 'S';
5331 case BuiltinType::Char32:
5332 case BuiltinType::UInt: return 'I';
5333 case BuiltinType::ULong:
5334 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
5335 case BuiltinType::UInt128: return 'T';
5336 case BuiltinType::ULongLong: return 'Q';
5337 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5338 case BuiltinType::SChar: return 'c';
5339 case BuiltinType::Short: return 's';
5340 case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5341 case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
5342 case BuiltinType::Int: return 'i';
5343 case BuiltinType::Long:
5344 return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
5345 case BuiltinType::LongLong: return 'q';
5346 case BuiltinType::Int128: return 't';
5347 case BuiltinType::Float: return 'f';
5348 case BuiltinType::Double: return 'd';
5349 case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
5350 case BuiltinType::NullPtr: return '*'; // like char*
5351
5352 case BuiltinType::Half:
5353 // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5354 return ' ';
5355
5356 case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5357 case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5358 case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5359 llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5360
5361 // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5362 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5363 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5364 case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5365 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5366 case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5367 case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
5368 case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
5369 case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
5370 case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5371 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5372 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5373 case BuiltinType::KIND:
5374 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5375 llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
5376 }
5377 llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
5378 }
5379
ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext * C,const EnumType * ET)5380 static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5381 EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5382
5383 // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5384 if (!Enum->isFixed())
5385 return 'i';
5386
5387 // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
5388 const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5389 return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
5390 }
5391
EncodeBitField(const ASTContext * Ctx,std::string & S,QualType T,const FieldDecl * FD)5392 static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
5393 QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
5394 assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
5395 S += 'b';
5396 // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5397 // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5398 // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5399 // bitfield, then the size in bits. For example, in this structure:
5400 //
5401 // struct
5402 // {
5403 // int integer;
5404 // int flags:2;
5405 // };
5406 // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5407 // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime. The reason for this extra
5408 // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5409 // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5410 // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
5411 if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
5412 const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5413 const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
5414 S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
5415 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5416 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
5417 else {
5418 const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5419 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5420 }
5421 }
5422 S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
5423 }
5424
5425 // FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T,std::string & S,bool ExpandPointedToStructures,bool ExpandStructures,const FieldDecl * FD,bool OutermostType,bool EncodingProperty,bool StructField,bool EncodeBlockParameters,bool EncodeClassNames,bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,QualType * NotEncodedT) const5426 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5427 bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5428 bool ExpandStructures,
5429 const FieldDecl *FD,
5430 bool OutermostType,
5431 bool EncodingProperty,
5432 bool StructField,
5433 bool EncodeBlockParameters,
5434 bool EncodeClassNames,
5435 bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5436 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
5437 CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5438 switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5439 case Type::Builtin:
5440 case Type::Enum:
5441 if (FD && FD->isBitField())
5442 return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
5443 if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5444 S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5445 else
5446 S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
5447 return;
5448
5449 case Type::Complex: {
5450 const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
5451 S += 'j';
5452 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
5453 return;
5454 }
5455
5456 case Type::Atomic: {
5457 const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5458 S += 'A';
5459 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
5460 return;
5461 }
5462
5463 // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5464 case Type::Pointer:
5465 case Type::LValueReference:
5466 case Type::RValueReference: {
5467 QualType PointeeTy;
5468 if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5469 const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5470 if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5471 S += ':';
5472 return;
5473 }
5474 PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5475 } else {
5476 PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5477 }
5478
5479 bool isReadOnly = false;
5480 // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5481 // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'. The read-only qualifier of
5482 // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
5483 // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
5484 if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
5485 if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5486 isReadOnly = true;
5487 S += 'r';
5488 }
5489 } else if (OutermostType) {
5490 QualType P = PointeeTy;
5491 while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5492 P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5493 if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5494 isReadOnly = true;
5495 S += 'r';
5496 }
5497 }
5498 if (isReadOnly) {
5499 // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5500 // combinations need to be rearranged.
5501 // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
5502 if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
5503 S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
5504 }
5505
5506 if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5507 // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5508 // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
5509 if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
5510 S += '*';
5511 return;
5512 }
5513 } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
5514 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5515 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5516 S += '#';
5517 return;
5518 }
5519 // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5520 if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5521 S += '@';
5522 return;
5523 }
5524 // fall through...
5525 }
5526 S += '^';
5527 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5528
5529 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
5530 nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
5531 NotEncodedT);
5532 return;
5533 }
5534
5535 case Type::ConstantArray:
5536 case Type::IncompleteArray:
5537 case Type::VariableArray: {
5538 const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5539
5540 if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
5541 // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5542 S += '^';
5543
5544 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
5545 false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5546 } else {
5547 S += '[';
5548
5549 if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5550 S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5551 else {
5552 //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
5553 assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5554 "Unknown array type!");
5555 S += '0';
5556 }
5557
5558 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
5559 false, ExpandStructures, FD,
5560 false, false, false, false, false, false,
5561 NotEncodedT);
5562 S += ']';
5563 }
5564 return;
5565 }
5566
5567 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5568 case Type::FunctionProto:
5569 S += '?';
5570 return;
5571
5572 case Type::Record: {
5573 RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
5574 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
5575 // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5576 if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5577 S += II->getName();
5578 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5579 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5580 const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
5581 llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5582 TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
5583 TemplateArgs.data(),
5584 TemplateArgs.size(),
5585 (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
5586 }
5587 } else {
5588 S += '?';
5589 }
5590 if (ExpandStructures) {
5591 S += '=';
5592 if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5593 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
5594 } else {
5595 for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
5596 if (FD) {
5597 S += '"';
5598 S += Field->getNameAsString();
5599 S += '"';
5600 }
5601
5602 // Special case bit-fields.
5603 if (Field->isBitField()) {
5604 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
5605 Field);
5606 } else {
5607 QualType qt = Field->getType();
5608 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5609 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5610 FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5611 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5612 /*StructField*/true,
5613 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
5614 }
5615 }
5616 }
5617 }
5618 S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
5619 return;
5620 }
5621
5622 case Type::BlockPointer: {
5623 const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
5624 S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
5625 if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
5626 const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
5627
5628 S += '<';
5629 // Block return type
5630 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5631 FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5632 FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5633 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
5634 NotEncodedT);
5635 // Block self
5636 S += "@?";
5637 // Block parameters
5638 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
5639 for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5640 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5641 I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5642 false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5643 false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
5644 false, NotEncodedT);
5645 }
5646 S += '>';
5647 }
5648 return;
5649 }
5650
5651 case Type::ObjCObject: {
5652 // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5653 QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5654 if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5655 S += "{objc_object=}";
5656 return;
5657 }
5658 else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5659 S += "{objc_class=}";
5660 return;
5661 }
5662 }
5663
5664 case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5665 // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5666 // @encode(class_name)
5667 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
5668 S += '{';
5669 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
5670 S += '=';
5671 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5672 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5673 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5674 const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
5675 if (Field->isBitField())
5676 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
5677 else
5678 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5679 false, false, false, false, false,
5680 EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5681 NotEncodedT);
5682 }
5683 S += '}';
5684 return;
5685 }
5686
5687 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5688 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5689 if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5690 S += '@';
5691 return;
5692 }
5693
5694 if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5695 // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5696 // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5697 // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
5698 S += '#';
5699 return;
5700 }
5701
5702 if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
5703 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
5704 ExpandPointedToStructures,
5705 ExpandStructures, FD);
5706 if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
5707 // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5708 // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
5709 S += '"';
5710 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
5711 S += '<';
5712 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
5713 S += '>';
5714 }
5715 S += '"';
5716 }
5717 return;
5718 }
5719
5720 QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5721 if (!EncodingProperty &&
5722 isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5723 !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
5724 // Another historical/compatibility reason.
5725 // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
5726 // {...};
5727 S += '^';
5728 if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
5729 // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
5730 ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5731 SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5732 DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5733 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5734 if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5735 S += '{';
5736 S += OI->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
5737 S += '}';
5738 return;
5739 }
5740 }
5741 }
5742 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5743 false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
5744 nullptr,
5745 false, false, false, false, false,
5746 /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
5747 return;
5748 }
5749
5750 S += '@';
5751 if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5752 (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
5753 S += '"';
5754 S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
5755 for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
5756 S += '<';
5757 S += I->getObjCRuntimeNameAsString();
5758 S += '>';
5759 }
5760 S += '"';
5761 }
5762 return;
5763 }
5764
5765 // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
5766 // FIXME: we shoul do better than that. 'M' is available.
5767 case Type::MemberPointer:
5768 // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
5769 //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5770 case Type::Vector:
5771 case Type::ExtVector:
5772 // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
5773 { if (NotEncodedT)
5774 *NotEncodedT = T;
5775 return;
5776 }
5777
5778 // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5779 // Just ignore it.
5780 case Type::Auto:
5781 return;
5782
5783
5784 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5785 #define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5786 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5787 case Type::KIND:
5788 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5789 case Type::KIND:
5790 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5791 case Type::KIND:
5792 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5793 llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
5794 }
5795 llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
5796 }
5797
getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl * RDecl,std::string & S,const FieldDecl * FD,bool includeVBases,QualType * NotEncodedT) const5798 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5799 std::string &S,
5800 const FieldDecl *FD,
5801 bool includeVBases,
5802 QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
5803 assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5804 assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5805 if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5806 return;
5807
5808 CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5809 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5810 const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5811
5812 if (CXXRec) {
5813 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5814 if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5815 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
5816 if (base->isEmpty())
5817 continue;
5818 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
5819 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5820 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5821 }
5822 }
5823 }
5824
5825 unsigned i = 0;
5826 for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
5827 uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5828 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5829 std::make_pair(offs, Field));
5830 ++i;
5831 }
5832
5833 if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
5834 for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5835 CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
5836 if (base->isEmpty())
5837 continue;
5838 uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
5839 if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5840 FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
5841 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5842 std::make_pair(offs, base));
5843 }
5844 }
5845
5846 CharUnits size;
5847 if (CXXRec) {
5848 size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5849 } else {
5850 size = layout.getSize();
5851 }
5852
5853 #ifndef NDEBUG
5854 uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
5855 #endif
5856 std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5857 CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5858
5859 if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5860 (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
5861 if (FD) {
5862 S += "\"_vptr$";
5863 std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5864 if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5865 S += recname;
5866 S += '"';
5867 }
5868 S += "^^?";
5869 #ifndef NDEBUG
5870 CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
5871 #endif
5872 }
5873
5874 if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5875 // Mark the end of the structure.
5876 uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5877 FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5878 std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
5879 }
5880
5881 for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
5882 #ifndef NDEBUG
5883 assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
5884 if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5885 uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5886 // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5887 // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5888 // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5889 // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5890 // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5891 // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5892 // longer then though.
5893 CurOffs += padding;
5894 }
5895 #endif
5896
5897 NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
5898 if (!dcl)
5899 break; // reached end of structure.
5900
5901 if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5902 // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5903 // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5904 // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5905 // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5906 getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
5907 NotEncodedT);
5908 assert(!base->isEmpty());
5909 #ifndef NDEBUG
5910 CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
5911 #endif
5912 } else {
5913 FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5914 if (FD) {
5915 S += '"';
5916 S += field->getNameAsString();
5917 S += '"';
5918 }
5919
5920 if (field->isBitField()) {
5921 EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
5922 #ifndef NDEBUG
5923 CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
5924 #endif
5925 } else {
5926 QualType qt = field->getType();
5927 getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5928 getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5929 /*OutermostType*/false,
5930 /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5931 /*StructField*/true,
5932 false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
5933 #ifndef NDEBUG
5934 CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
5935 #endif
5936 }
5937 }
5938 }
5939 }
5940
getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,std::string & S) const5941 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5942 std::string& S) const {
5943 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5944 S += 'n';
5945 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5946 S += 'N';
5947 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5948 S += 'o';
5949 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5950 S += 'O';
5951 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5952 S += 'R';
5953 if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5954 S += 'V';
5955 }
5956
getObjCIdDecl() const5957 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5958 if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
5959 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, { }, { });
5960 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
5961 ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
5962 }
5963 return ObjCIdDecl;
5964 }
5965
getObjCSelDecl() const5966 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5967 if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
5968 QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5969 ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
5970 }
5971 return ObjCSelDecl;
5972 }
5973
getObjCClassDecl() const5974 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5975 if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
5976 QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, { }, { });
5977 T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
5978 ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
5979 }
5980 return ObjCClassDecl;
5981 }
5982
getObjCProtocolDecl() const5983 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5984 if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5985 ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5986 = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5987 SourceLocation(),
5988 &Idents.get("Protocol"),
5989 /*typeParamList=*/nullptr,
5990 /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
5991 SourceLocation(), true);
5992 }
5993
5994 return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5995 }
5996
5997 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5998 // __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5999 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6000
CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)6001 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6002 // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
6003 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
6004 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
6005 }
6006
CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)6007 static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6008 // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
6009 QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6010 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
6011 }
6012
6013 static TypedefDecl *
CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)6014 CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6015 // struct __va_list
6016 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
6017 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6018 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6019 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6020 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6021 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6022 /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
6023 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
6024 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
6025 NS->setImplicit();
6026 VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
6027 }
6028
6029 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6030
6031 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6032 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6033 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6034
6035 // void *__stack;
6036 FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6037 FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
6038
6039 // void *__gr_top;
6040 FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6041 FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
6042
6043 // void *__vr_top;
6044 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6045 FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
6046
6047 // int __gr_offs;
6048 FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
6049 FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
6050
6051 // int __vr_offs;
6052 FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
6053 FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
6054
6055 // Create fields
6056 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6057 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6058 VaListTagDecl,
6059 SourceLocation(),
6060 SourceLocation(),
6061 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6062 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6063 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6064 /*Mutable=*/false,
6065 ICIS_NoInit);
6066 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6067 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6068 }
6069 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6070 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6071 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6072
6073 // } __builtin_va_list;
6074 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
6075 }
6076
CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)6077 static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6078 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6079 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6080
6081 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
6082 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6083
6084 const size_t NumFields = 5;
6085 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6086 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6087
6088 // unsigned char gpr;
6089 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6090 FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6091
6092 // unsigned char fpr;
6093 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6094 FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
6095
6096 // unsigned short reserved;
6097 FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
6098 FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
6099
6100 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6101 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6102 FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
6103
6104 // void* reg_save_area;
6105 FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6106 FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
6107
6108 // Create fields
6109 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6110 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
6111 SourceLocation(),
6112 SourceLocation(),
6113 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6114 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6115 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6116 /*Mutable=*/false,
6117 ICIS_NoInit);
6118 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6119 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6120 }
6121 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6122 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6123 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6124
6125 // } __va_list_tag;
6126 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6127 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6128
6129 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6130 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6131
6132 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6133 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6134 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6135 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6136 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6137 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6138 }
6139
6140 static TypedefDecl *
CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)6141 CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6142 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6143 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6144 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
6145 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6146
6147 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6148 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6149 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6150
6151 // unsigned gp_offset;
6152 FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6153 FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
6154
6155 // unsigned fp_offset;
6156 FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6157 FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6158
6159 // void* overflow_arg_area;
6160 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6161 FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6162
6163 // void* reg_save_area;
6164 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6165 FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6166
6167 // Create fields
6168 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6169 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6170 VaListTagDecl,
6171 SourceLocation(),
6172 SourceLocation(),
6173 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6174 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6175 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6176 /*Mutable=*/false,
6177 ICIS_NoInit);
6178 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6179 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6180 }
6181 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6182 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6183 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6184
6185 // } __va_list_tag;
6186 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6187 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6188
6189 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6190 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6191
6192 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6193 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6194 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6195 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6196 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
6197 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6198 }
6199
CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)6200 static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6201 // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6202 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
6203 QualType IntArrayType
6204 = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
6205 Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6206 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6207 }
6208
6209 static TypedefDecl *
CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)6210 CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6211 // struct __va_list
6212 RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
6213 if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6214 // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6215 NamespaceDecl *NS;
6216 NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6217 Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6218 /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6219 SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
6220 /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
6221 NS->setImplicit();
6222 VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
6223 }
6224
6225 VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6226
6227 // void * __ap;
6228 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6229 VaListDecl,
6230 SourceLocation(),
6231 SourceLocation(),
6232 &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6233 Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
6234 /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6235 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6236 /*Mutable=*/false,
6237 ICIS_NoInit);
6238 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6239 VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6240
6241 // };
6242 VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6243
6244 // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
6245 QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6246 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
6247 }
6248
6249 static TypedefDecl *
CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context)6250 CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6251 // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6252 RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6253 VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
6254 VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6255
6256 const size_t NumFields = 4;
6257 QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6258 const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6259
6260 // long __gpr;
6261 FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6262 FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6263
6264 // long __fpr;
6265 FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6266 FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6267
6268 // void *__overflow_arg_area;
6269 FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6270 FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6271
6272 // void *__reg_save_area;
6273 FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6274 FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6275
6276 // Create fields
6277 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6278 FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6279 VaListTagDecl,
6280 SourceLocation(),
6281 SourceLocation(),
6282 &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6283 FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6284 /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6285 /*Mutable=*/false,
6286 ICIS_NoInit);
6287 Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6288 VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6289 }
6290 VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6291 QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6292 Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6293
6294 // } __va_list_tag;
6295 TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6296 Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6297 QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6298 Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6299
6300 // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6301 llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6302 QualType VaListTagArrayType
6303 = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6304 Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
6305
6306 return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6307 }
6308
CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext * Context,TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind)6309 static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6310 TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6311 switch (Kind) {
6312 case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6313 return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6314 case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6315 return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6316 case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6317 return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6318 case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6319 return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6320 case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6321 return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6322 case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6323 return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6324 case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6325 return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6326 case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6327 return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6328 }
6329
6330 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6331 }
6332
getBuiltinVaListDecl() const6333 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
6334 if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
6335 BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
6336 assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6337 }
6338
6339 return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6340 }
6341
getVaListTagType() const6342 QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6343 // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6344 // declaration.
6345 if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6346 (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6347
6348 return VaListTagTy;
6349 }
6350
setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl * Decl)6351 void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
6352 assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
6353 "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
6354
6355 ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
6356 }
6357
6358 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6359 /// lookup.
6360 TemplateName
getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,UnresolvedSetIterator End) const6361 ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6362 UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
6363 unsigned size = End - Begin;
6364 assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6365
6366 void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6367 size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6368 OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6369
6370 NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
6371 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
6372 NamedDecl *D = *I;
6373 assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6374 (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6375 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6376 *Storage++ = D;
6377 }
6378
6379 return TemplateName(OT);
6380 }
6381
6382 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6383 /// template name such as \c std::vector.
6384 TemplateName
getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,bool TemplateKeyword,TemplateDecl * Template) const6385 ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6386 bool TemplateKeyword,
6387 TemplateDecl *Template) const {
6388 assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6389
6390 // FIXME: Canonicalization?
6391 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6392 QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6393
6394 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6395 QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6396 QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6397 if (!QTN) {
6398 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6399 QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6400 QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6401 }
6402
6403 return TemplateName(QTN);
6404 }
6405
6406 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6407 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
6408 TemplateName
getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,const IdentifierInfo * Name) const6409 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6410 const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
6411 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6412 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6413
6414 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6415 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6416
6417 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6418 DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6419 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6420
6421 if (QTN)
6422 return TemplateName(QTN);
6423
6424 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6425 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
6426 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6427 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
6428 } else {
6429 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
6430 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6431 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
6432 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6433 DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6434 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6435 (void)CheckQTN;
6436 }
6437
6438 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6439 return TemplateName(QTN);
6440 }
6441
6442 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6443 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6444 TemplateName
getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier * NNS,OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const6445 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6446 OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
6447 assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6448 "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6449
6450 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6451 DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
6452
6453 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6454 DependentTemplateName *QTN
6455 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6456
6457 if (QTN)
6458 return TemplateName(QTN);
6459
6460 NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6461 if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
6462 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6463 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
6464 } else {
6465 TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
6466 QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6467 DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
6468
6469 DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6470 = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6471 assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6472 (void)CheckQTN;
6473 }
6474
6475 DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6476 return TemplateName(QTN);
6477 }
6478
6479 TemplateName
getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl * param,TemplateName replacement) const6480 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6481 TemplateName replacement) const {
6482 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6483 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
6484
6485 void *insertPos = nullptr;
6486 SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6487 = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6488
6489 if (!subst) {
6490 subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6491 SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6492 }
6493
6494 return TemplateName(subst);
6495 }
6496
6497 TemplateName
getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl * Param,const TemplateArgument & ArgPack) const6498 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6499 const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6500 ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6501 llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6502 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
6503
6504 void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6505 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6506 = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6507
6508 if (!Subst) {
6509 Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
6510 ArgPack.pack_size(),
6511 ArgPack.pack_begin());
6512 SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6513 }
6514
6515 return TemplateName(Subst);
6516 }
6517
6518 /// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
6519 /// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6520 /// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const6521 CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
6522 switch (Type) {
6523 case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
6524 case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6525 case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
6526 case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6527 case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6528 case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6529 case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6530 case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6531 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6532 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6533 case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6534 }
6535
6536 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
6537 }
6538
6539 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6540 // Type Predicates.
6541 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6542
6543 /// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6544 /// garbage collection attribute.
6545 ///
getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const6546 Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
6547 if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
6548 return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6549
6550 assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
6551 Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6552
6553 // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6554 // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6555 // as __strong.
6556 if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6557 if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6558 return Qualifiers::Strong;
6559 else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6560 return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6561 } else {
6562 // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6563 // pointer.
6564 #ifndef NDEBUG
6565 QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6566 while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6567 CT = AT->getElementType();
6568 assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6569 #endif
6570 }
6571 return GCAttrs;
6572 }
6573
6574 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6575 // Type Compatibility Testing
6576 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6577
6578 /// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
6579 /// compatible.
areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType * LHS,const VectorType * RHS)6580 static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6581 const VectorType *RHS) {
6582 assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
6583 return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
6584 LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
6585 }
6586
areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,QualType SecondVec)6587 bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6588 QualType SecondVec) {
6589 assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6590 assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6591
6592 if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6593 return true;
6594
6595 // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6596 // equivalent GCC vector types.
6597 const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6598 const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6599 if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
6600 hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
6601 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6602 First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6603 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6604 Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
6605 return true;
6606
6607 return false;
6608 }
6609
6610 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6611 // ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6612 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6613
6614 /// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6615 /// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
6616 bool
ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl * lProto,ObjCProtocolDecl * rProto) const6617 ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6618 ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
6619 if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
6620 return true;
6621 for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6622 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
6623 return true;
6624 return false;
6625 }
6626
6627 /// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare Class<pr,...> and
6628 /// Class<pr1, ...>.
ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,QualType rhs)6629 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6630 QualType rhs) {
6631 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6632 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6633 assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6634
6635 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
6636 bool match = false;
6637 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
6638 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6639 match = true;
6640 break;
6641 }
6642 }
6643 if (!match)
6644 return false;
6645 }
6646 return true;
6647 }
6648
6649 /// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6650 /// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,QualType rhs,bool compare)6651 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6652 bool compare) {
6653 // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
6654 if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
6655 lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6656 return true;
6657 else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
6658 rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6659 return true;
6660
6661 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
6662 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6663
6664 if (!rhsOPT) return false;
6665
6666 if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
6667 // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
6668 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6669 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6670 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
6671 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6672 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6673 // through its super class and categories.
6674 if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
6675 return false;
6676 }
6677 }
6678 // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6679 return true;
6680 }
6681 // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
6682 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
6683 bool match = false;
6684
6685 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6686 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6687 // through its super class and categories.
6688 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
6689 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6690 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6691 match = true;
6692 break;
6693 }
6694 }
6695 // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
6696 // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6697 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6698 for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
6699 // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6700 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6701 // through its super class and categories.
6702 if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
6703 match = true;
6704 break;
6705 }
6706 }
6707 }
6708 if (!match)
6709 return false;
6710 }
6711
6712 return true;
6713 }
6714
6715 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6716 assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6717
6718 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
6719 lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
6720 // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
6721 for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
6722 bool match = false;
6723
6724 // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
6725 // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6726 // through its super class and categories.
6727 // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6728 // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6729 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
6730 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6731 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6732 match = true;
6733 break;
6734 }
6735 }
6736 if (!match)
6737 return false;
6738 }
6739
6740 // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6741 // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6742 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6743 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6744 CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6745 // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6746 // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6747 // assume that it is mismatch.
6748 if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6749 return false;
6750 for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
6751 bool match = false;
6752 for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
6753 if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6754 (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6755 match = true;
6756 break;
6757 }
6758 }
6759 if (!match)
6760 return false;
6761 }
6762 }
6763 return true;
6764 }
6765 return false;
6766 }
6767
6768 /// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
6769 /// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS. This handles validation of any
6770 /// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6771 ///
canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType * LHSOPT,const ObjCObjectPointerType * RHSOPT)6772 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6773 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
6774 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6775 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6776
6777 // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
6778 if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6779 RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
6780 return true;
6781
6782 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
6783 // __kindof types.
6784 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
6785 if (succeeded)
6786 return true;
6787
6788 if (!RHS->isKindOfType())
6789 return false;
6790
6791 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
6792 // we can assign the other way.
6793 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6794 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this));
6795 };
6796
6797 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId()) {
6798 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6799 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6800 false));
6801 }
6802
6803 if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass()) {
6804 return finish(ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6805 QualType(RHSOPT,0)));
6806 }
6807
6808 // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6809 if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface()) {
6810 return finish(canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS));
6811 }
6812
6813 return false;
6814 }
6815
6816 /// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
6817 /// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
6818 /// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6819 /// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6820 /// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(const ObjCObjectPointerType * LHSOPT,const ObjCObjectPointerType * RHSOPT,bool BlockReturnType)6821 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6822 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6823 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6824 bool BlockReturnType) {
6825
6826 // Function object that propagates a successful result or handles
6827 // __kindof types.
6828 auto finish = [&](bool succeeded) -> bool {
6829 if (succeeded)
6830 return true;
6831
6832 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Expected = BlockReturnType ? RHSOPT : LHSOPT;
6833 if (!Expected->isKindOfType())
6834 return false;
6835
6836 // Strip off __kindof and protocol qualifiers, then check whether
6837 // we can assign the other way.
6838 return canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6839 RHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6840 LHSOPT->stripObjCKindOfTypeAndQuals(*this),
6841 BlockReturnType);
6842 };
6843
6844 if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
6845 return true;
6846
6847 if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6848 return finish(RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ||
6849 RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType());
6850 }
6851
6852 if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
6853 return finish(ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6854 QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6855 false));
6856
6857 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6858 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6859 if (LHS && RHS) { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6860 if (LHS != RHS) {
6861 if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
6862 return finish(BlockReturnType);
6863 if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
6864 return finish(!BlockReturnType);
6865 }
6866 else
6867 return true;
6868 }
6869 return false;
6870 }
6871
6872 /// Comparison routine for Objective-C protocols to be used with
6873 /// llvm::array_pod_sort.
compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const * lhs,ObjCProtocolDecl * const * rhs)6874 static int compareObjCProtocolsByName(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *lhs,
6875 ObjCProtocolDecl * const *rhs) {
6876 return (*lhs)->getName().compare((*rhs)->getName());
6877
6878 }
6879
6880 /// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6881 /// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects with
6882 /// the given common base.
6883 /// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6884 /// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6885 static
getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext & Context,const ObjCInterfaceDecl * CommonBase,const ObjCObjectPointerType * LHSOPT,const ObjCObjectPointerType * RHSOPT,SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl * > & IntersectionSet)6886 void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6887 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *CommonBase,
6888 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6889 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6890 SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionSet) {
6891
6892 const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6893 const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6894 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6895 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
6896
6897 // Add all of the protocols for the LHS.
6898 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSProtocolSet;
6899
6900 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
6901 for (auto proto : LHS->quals()) {
6902 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, LHSProtocolSet);
6903 }
6904
6905 // Also add the protocols associated with the LHS interface.
6906 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(), LHSProtocolSet);
6907
6908 // Add all of the protocls for the RHS.
6909 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSProtocolSet;
6910
6911 // Start with the protocol qualifiers.
6912 for (auto proto : RHS->quals()) {
6913 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(proto, RHSProtocolSet);
6914 }
6915
6916 // Also add the protocols associated with the RHS interface.
6917 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), RHSProtocolSet);
6918
6919 // Compute the intersection of the collected protocol sets.
6920 for (auto proto : LHSProtocolSet) {
6921 if (RHSProtocolSet.count(proto))
6922 IntersectionSet.push_back(proto);
6923 }
6924
6925 // Compute the set of protocols that is implied by either the common type or
6926 // the protocols within the intersection.
6927 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> ImpliedProtocols;
6928 Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(CommonBase, ImpliedProtocols);
6929
6930 // Remove any implied protocols from the list of inherited protocols.
6931 if (!ImpliedProtocols.empty()) {
6932 IntersectionSet.erase(
6933 std::remove_if(IntersectionSet.begin(),
6934 IntersectionSet.end(),
6935 [&](ObjCProtocolDecl *proto) -> bool {
6936 return ImpliedProtocols.count(proto) > 0;
6937 }),
6938 IntersectionSet.end());
6939 }
6940
6941 // Sort the remaining protocols by name.
6942 llvm::array_pod_sort(IntersectionSet.begin(), IntersectionSet.end(),
6943 compareObjCProtocolsByName);
6944 }
6945
6946 /// Determine whether the first type is a subtype of the second.
canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext & ctx,QualType lhs,QualType rhs)6947 static bool canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ASTContext &ctx, QualType lhs,
6948 QualType rhs) {
6949 // Common case: two object pointers.
6950 const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6951 const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6952 if (lhsOPT && rhsOPT)
6953 return ctx.canAssignObjCInterfaces(lhsOPT, rhsOPT);
6954
6955 // Two block pointers.
6956 const BlockPointerType *lhsBlock = lhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
6957 const BlockPointerType *rhsBlock = rhs->getAs<BlockPointerType>();
6958 if (lhsBlock && rhsBlock)
6959 return ctx.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhs, rhs);
6960
6961 // If either is an unqualified 'id' and the other is a block, it's
6962 // acceptable.
6963 if ((lhsOPT && lhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && rhsBlock) ||
6964 (rhsOPT && rhsOPT->isObjCIdType() && lhsBlock))
6965 return true;
6966
6967 return false;
6968 }
6969
6970 // Check that the given Objective-C type argument lists are equivalent.
sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext & ctx,const ObjCInterfaceDecl * iface,ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,bool stripKindOf)6971 static bool sameObjCTypeArgs(ASTContext &ctx,
6972 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *iface,
6973 ArrayRef<QualType> lhsArgs,
6974 ArrayRef<QualType> rhsArgs,
6975 bool stripKindOf) {
6976 if (lhsArgs.size() != rhsArgs.size())
6977 return false;
6978
6979 ObjCTypeParamList *typeParams = iface->getTypeParamList();
6980 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lhsArgs.size(); i != n; ++i) {
6981 if (ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
6982 continue;
6983
6984 switch (typeParams->begin()[i]->getVariance()) {
6985 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Invariant:
6986 if (!stripKindOf ||
6987 !ctx.hasSameType(lhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx),
6988 rhsArgs[i].stripObjCKindOfType(ctx))) {
6989 return false;
6990 }
6991 break;
6992
6993 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Covariant:
6994 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, lhsArgs[i], rhsArgs[i]))
6995 return false;
6996 break;
6997
6998 case ObjCTypeParamVariance::Contravariant:
6999 if (!canAssignObjCObjectTypes(ctx, rhsArgs[i], lhsArgs[i]))
7000 return false;
7001 break;
7002 }
7003 }
7004
7005 return true;
7006 }
7007
areCommonBaseCompatible(const ObjCObjectPointerType * Lptr,const ObjCObjectPointerType * Rptr)7008 QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
7009 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
7010 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
7011 const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
7012 const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
7013 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
7014 const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
7015
7016 if (!LDecl || !RDecl)
7017 return QualType();
7018
7019 // Follow the left-hand side up the class hierarchy until we either hit a
7020 // root or find the RHS. Record the ancestors in case we don't find it.
7021 llvm::SmallDenseMap<const ObjCInterfaceDecl *, const ObjCObjectType *, 4>
7022 LHSAncestors;
7023 while (true) {
7024 // Record this ancestor. We'll need this if the common type isn't in the
7025 // path from the LHS to the root.
7026 LHSAncestors[LHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl()] = LHS;
7027
7028 if (declaresSameEntity(LHS->getInterface(), RDecl)) {
7029 // Get the type arguments.
7030 ArrayRef<QualType> LHSTypeArgs = LHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7031 bool anyChanges = false;
7032 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7033 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
7034 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7035 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
7036 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
7037 return QualType();
7038 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7039 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7040 // arguments.
7041 LHSTypeArgs = { };
7042 anyChanges = true;
7043 }
7044
7045 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
7046 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
7047 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, LHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7048 Protocols);
7049 if (!Protocols.empty())
7050 anyChanges = true;
7051
7052 // If anything in the LHS will have changed, build a new result type.
7053 if (anyChanges) {
7054 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(LHS->getInterface());
7055 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, LHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
7056 LHS->isKindOfType());
7057 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7058 }
7059
7060 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(LHS, 0));
7061 }
7062
7063 // Find the superclass.
7064 QualType LHSSuperType = LHS->getSuperClassType();
7065 if (LHSSuperType.isNull())
7066 break;
7067
7068 LHS = LHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7069 }
7070
7071 // We didn't find anything by following the LHS to its root; now check
7072 // the RHS against the cached set of ancestors.
7073 while (true) {
7074 auto KnownLHS = LHSAncestors.find(RHS->getInterface()->getCanonicalDecl());
7075 if (KnownLHS != LHSAncestors.end()) {
7076 LHS = KnownLHS->second;
7077
7078 // Get the type arguments.
7079 ArrayRef<QualType> RHSTypeArgs = RHS->getTypeArgsAsWritten();
7080 bool anyChanges = false;
7081 if (LHS->isSpecialized() && RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7082 // Both have type arguments, compare them.
7083 if (!sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7084 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHS->getTypeArgs(),
7085 /*stripKindOf=*/true))
7086 return QualType();
7087 } else if (LHS->isSpecialized() != RHS->isSpecialized()) {
7088 // If only one has type arguments, the result will not have type
7089 // arguments.
7090 RHSTypeArgs = { };
7091 anyChanges = true;
7092 }
7093
7094 // Compute the intersection of protocols.
7095 SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
7096 getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, RHS->getInterface(), Lptr, Rptr,
7097 Protocols);
7098 if (!Protocols.empty())
7099 anyChanges = true;
7100
7101 if (anyChanges) {
7102 QualType Result = getObjCInterfaceType(RHS->getInterface());
7103 Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, RHSTypeArgs, Protocols,
7104 RHS->isKindOfType());
7105 return getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
7106 }
7107
7108 return getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType(RHS, 0));
7109 }
7110
7111 // Find the superclass of the RHS.
7112 QualType RHSSuperType = RHS->getSuperClassType();
7113 if (RHSSuperType.isNull())
7114 break;
7115
7116 RHS = RHSSuperType->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7117 }
7118
7119 return QualType();
7120 }
7121
canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType * LHS,const ObjCObjectType * RHS)7122 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
7123 const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
7124 assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
7125 assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
7126
7127 // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
7128 // the LHS.
7129 ObjCInterfaceDecl *LHSInterface = LHS->getInterface();
7130 bool IsSuperClass = LHSInterface->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
7131 if (!IsSuperClass)
7132 return false;
7133
7134 // If the LHS has protocol qualifiers, determine whether all of them are
7135 // satisfied by the RHS (i.e., the RHS has a superset of the protocols in the
7136 // LHS).
7137 if (LHS->getNumProtocols() > 0) {
7138 // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
7139 // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
7140 // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
7141 // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
7142 llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
7143 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
7144 // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
7145 // qualifiers.
7146 for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
7147 CollectInheritedProtocols(RHSPI, SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
7148 // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
7149 if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
7150 return false;
7151
7152 for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
7153 bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
7154 for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
7155 if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
7156 SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
7157 break;
7158 }
7159 if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
7160 return false;
7161 }
7162 }
7163
7164 // If the LHS is specialized, we may need to check type arguments.
7165 if (LHS->isSpecialized()) {
7166 // Follow the superclass chain until we've matched the LHS class in the
7167 // hierarchy. This substitutes type arguments through.
7168 const ObjCObjectType *RHSSuper = RHS;
7169 while (!declaresSameEntity(RHSSuper->getInterface(), LHSInterface))
7170 RHSSuper = RHSSuper->getSuperClassType()->castAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7171
7172 // If the RHS is specializd, compare type arguments.
7173 if (RHSSuper->isSpecialized() &&
7174 !sameObjCTypeArgs(*this, LHS->getInterface(),
7175 LHS->getTypeArgs(), RHSSuper->getTypeArgs(),
7176 /*stripKindOf=*/true)) {
7177 return false;
7178 }
7179 }
7180
7181 return true;
7182 }
7183
areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS,QualType RHS)7184 bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7185 // get the "pointed to" types
7186 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7187 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7188
7189 if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
7190 return false;
7191
7192 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
7193 canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
7194 }
7195
canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To,QualType From)7196 bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
7197 return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
7198 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7199 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
7200 }
7201
7202 /// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
7203 /// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
7204 /// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
7205 /// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS,QualType RHS,bool CompareUnqualified)7206 bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
7207 bool CompareUnqualified) {
7208 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
7209 return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
7210
7211 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
7212 }
7213
propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS,QualType RHS)7214 bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7215 return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
7216 }
7217
typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS,QualType RHS)7218 bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7219 return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
7220 }
7221
7222 /// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
7223 /// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
7224 /// QualType()
mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T,QualType SubType,bool OfBlockPointer,bool Unqualified)7225 QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
7226 bool OfBlockPointer,
7227 bool Unqualified) {
7228 if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
7229 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
7230 if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
7231 for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
7232 QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7233 QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7234 if (!MT.isNull())
7235 return MT;
7236 }
7237 }
7238 }
7239
7240 return QualType();
7241 }
7242
7243 /// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
7244 /// parameter types
mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs,QualType rhs,bool OfBlockPointer,bool Unqualified)7245 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7246 bool OfBlockPointer,
7247 bool Unqualified) {
7248 // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
7249 // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
7250 // type is compatible with a union member
7251 QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
7252 Unqualified);
7253 if (!lmerge.isNull())
7254 return lmerge;
7255
7256 QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
7257 Unqualified);
7258 if (!rmerge.isNull())
7259 return rmerge;
7260
7261 return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7262 }
7263
mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs,QualType rhs,bool OfBlockPointer,bool Unqualified)7264 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
7265 bool OfBlockPointer,
7266 bool Unqualified) {
7267 const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
7268 const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
7269 const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
7270 const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
7271 bool allLTypes = true;
7272 bool allRTypes = true;
7273
7274 // Check return type
7275 QualType retType;
7276 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7277 QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
7278 QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
7279 bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
7280 if (!UnqualifiedResult)
7281 UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
7282 retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
7283 }
7284 else
7285 retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
7286 Unqualified);
7287 if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
7288
7289 if (Unqualified)
7290 retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
7291
7292 CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
7293 CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
7294 if (Unqualified) {
7295 LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7296 RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
7297 }
7298
7299 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
7300 allLTypes = false;
7301 if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
7302 allRTypes = false;
7303
7304 // FIXME: double check this
7305 // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7306 // rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7307 // lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
7308 FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
7309 FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
7310
7311 // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
7312 if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
7313 return QualType();
7314
7315 // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
7316 if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
7317 return QualType();
7318 if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
7319 return QualType();
7320
7321 if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
7322 return QualType();
7323
7324 // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
7325 bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
7326
7327 if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7328 allLTypes = false;
7329 if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7330 allRTypes = false;
7331
7332 FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
7333
7334 if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
7335 assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
7336 "C++ shouldn't be here");
7337 // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
7338 if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
7339 return QualType();
7340
7341 // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
7342 if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
7343 return QualType();
7344
7345 if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
7346 return QualType();
7347
7348 if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
7349 !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
7350 return QualType();
7351
7352 // Check parameter type compatibility
7353 SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
7354 for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
7355 QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7356 QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7357 QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
7358 lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7359 if (paramType.isNull())
7360 return QualType();
7361
7362 if (Unqualified)
7363 paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
7364
7365 types.push_back(paramType);
7366 if (Unqualified) {
7367 lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7368 rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7369 }
7370
7371 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
7372 allLTypes = false;
7373 if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
7374 allRTypes = false;
7375 }
7376
7377 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7378 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
7379
7380 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7381 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
7382 return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
7383 }
7384
7385 if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7386 if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7387
7388 const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
7389 if (proto) {
7390 assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
7391 if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7392 // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7393 // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7394 // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7395 // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7396 // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
7397 for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7398 QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
7399
7400 // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
7401 // to pass enum values.
7402 if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7403 paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7404 if (paramTy.isNull())
7405 return QualType();
7406 }
7407
7408 if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7409 getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
7410 return QualType();
7411 }
7412
7413 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7414 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
7415
7416 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7417 EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
7418 return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
7419 }
7420
7421 if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7422 if (allRTypes) return rhs;
7423 return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
7424 }
7425
7426 /// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext & Context,const EnumType * ET,QualType other,bool isBlockReturnType)7427 static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7428 QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7429 // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7430 // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7431 // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7432 // type.
7433 QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7434 if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7435 if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7436 return other;
7437
7438 // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7439 // integral type of the same size.
7440 if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7441 Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7442 return other;
7443
7444 return QualType();
7445 }
7446
mergeTypes(QualType LHS,QualType RHS,bool OfBlockPointer,bool Unqualified,bool BlockReturnType)7447 QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
7448 bool OfBlockPointer,
7449 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
7450 // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7451 // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7452 // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
7453 // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7454 // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
7455 assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7456 assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
7457
7458 if (Unqualified) {
7459 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7460 RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7461 }
7462
7463 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7464 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7465
7466 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7467 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7468 return LHS;
7469
7470 // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
7471 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7472 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7473 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7474 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7475 // mismatch.
7476 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7477 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7478 LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
7479 return QualType();
7480
7481 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7482 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7483 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7484 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7485 // qualified __strong.
7486 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7487 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7488 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7489
7490 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7491 return QualType();
7492
7493 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7494 return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7495 }
7496 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7497 return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7498 }
7499 return QualType();
7500 }
7501
7502 // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
7503
7504 Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7505 Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
7506
7507 // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7508 // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7509 if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7510 if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7511
7512 // Same as above for arrays
7513 if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7514 LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7515 if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7516 RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7517
7518 // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7519 if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7520 if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7521
7522 // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7523 if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7524 if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
7525
7526 // If the canonical type classes don't match.
7527 if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
7528 // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7529 // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
7530 if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7531 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
7532 }
7533 if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7534 return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
7535 }
7536 // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
7537 if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7538 if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7539 return LHS;
7540 if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7541 return RHS;
7542 }
7543
7544 return QualType();
7545 }
7546
7547 // The canonical type classes match.
7548 switch (LHSClass) {
7549 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
7550 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
7551 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7552 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7553 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7554 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
7555 llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
7556
7557 case Type::Auto:
7558 case Type::LValueReference:
7559 case Type::RValueReference:
7560 case Type::MemberPointer:
7561 llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
7562
7563 case Type::ObjCInterface:
7564 case Type::IncompleteArray:
7565 case Type::VariableArray:
7566 case Type::FunctionProto:
7567 case Type::ExtVector:
7568 llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
7569
7570 case Type::Pointer:
7571 {
7572 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7573 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7574 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7575 if (Unqualified) {
7576 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7577 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7578 }
7579 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7580 Unqualified);
7581 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7582 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7583 return LHS;
7584 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7585 return RHS;
7586 return getPointerType(ResultType);
7587 }
7588 case Type::BlockPointer:
7589 {
7590 // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7591 QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7592 QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7593 if (Unqualified) {
7594 LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7595 RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7596 }
7597 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7598 Unqualified);
7599 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7600 if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7601 return LHS;
7602 if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7603 return RHS;
7604 return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7605 }
7606 case Type::Atomic:
7607 {
7608 // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7609 QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7610 QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7611 if (Unqualified) {
7612 LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7613 RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7614 }
7615 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7616 Unqualified);
7617 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7618 if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7619 return LHS;
7620 if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7621 return RHS;
7622 return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7623 }
7624 case Type::ConstantArray:
7625 {
7626 const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7627 const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7628 if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7629 return QualType();
7630
7631 QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7632 QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
7633 if (Unqualified) {
7634 LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7635 RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7636 }
7637
7638 QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
7639 if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7640 if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7641 return LHS;
7642 if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7643 return RHS;
7644 if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7645 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7646 if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7647 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7648 const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7649 const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
7650 if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7651 return LHS;
7652 if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7653 return RHS;
7654 if (LVAT) {
7655 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7656 // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7657 // has to be different.
7658 return LHS;
7659 }
7660 if (RVAT) {
7661 // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7662 // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7663 // has to be different.
7664 return RHS;
7665 }
7666 if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7667 if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
7668 return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7669 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7670 }
7671 case Type::FunctionNoProto:
7672 return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7673 case Type::Record:
7674 case Type::Enum:
7675 return QualType();
7676 case Type::Builtin:
7677 // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
7678 return QualType();
7679 case Type::Complex:
7680 // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7681 return QualType();
7682 case Type::Vector:
7683 // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
7684 if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7685 RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
7686 return LHS;
7687 return QualType();
7688 case Type::ObjCObject: {
7689 // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
7690 // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7691 // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
7692 const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7693 const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7694 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
7695 return LHS;
7696
7697 return QualType();
7698 }
7699 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
7700 if (OfBlockPointer) {
7701 if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7702 LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7703 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7704 BlockReturnType))
7705 return LHS;
7706 return QualType();
7707 }
7708 if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7709 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
7710 return LHS;
7711
7712 return QualType();
7713 }
7714 }
7715
7716 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
7717 }
7718
FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(const FunctionProtoType * FromFunctionType,const FunctionProtoType * ToFunctionType)7719 bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7720 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7721 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
7722 if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7723 ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
7724 return false;
7725 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7726 FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7727 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7728 ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7729 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
7730 for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7731 if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
7732 return false;
7733 }
7734 return true;
7735 }
7736
7737 /// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7738 /// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7739 /// return types.
mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS,QualType RHS)7740 QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7741 QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7742 RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7743 // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7744 if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7745 return LHS;
7746 if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7747 if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7748 return QualType();
7749 QualType OldReturnType =
7750 cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
7751 QualType NewReturnType =
7752 cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
7753 QualType ResReturnType =
7754 mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7755 if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7756 return QualType();
7757 if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7758 // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7759 // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7760 const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7761 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
7762 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7763 EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
7764 QualType ResultType =
7765 getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
7766 return ResultType;
7767 }
7768 }
7769 return QualType();
7770 }
7771
7772 // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7773 Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7774 Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7775 if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7776 // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7777 if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7778 LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7779 return QualType();
7780
7781 // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7782 // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7783 // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default). We fix
7784 // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7785 // qualified __strong.
7786 Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7787 Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7788 assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7789
7790 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7791 return QualType();
7792
7793 if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7794 return LHS;
7795 if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7796 return RHS;
7797 return QualType();
7798 }
7799
7800 if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7801 QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7802 QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7803 QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7804 if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7805 return LHS;
7806 if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7807 return RHS;
7808 }
7809 return QualType();
7810 }
7811
7812 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7813 // Integer Predicates
7814 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7815
getIntWidth(QualType T) const7816 unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
7817 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
7818 T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7819 if (T->isBooleanType())
7820 return 1;
7821 // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
7822 return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7823 }
7824
getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const7825 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
7826 assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
7827
7828 // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7829 if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7830 return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
7831 VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
7832
7833 // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7834 if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
7835 T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7836
7837 const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7838 assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
7839 switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7840 case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7841 case BuiltinType::SChar:
7842 return UnsignedCharTy;
7843 case BuiltinType::Short:
7844 return UnsignedShortTy;
7845 case BuiltinType::Int:
7846 return UnsignedIntTy;
7847 case BuiltinType::Long:
7848 return UnsignedLongTy;
7849 case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7850 return UnsignedLongLongTy;
7851 case BuiltinType::Int128:
7852 return UnsignedInt128Ty;
7853 default:
7854 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
7855 }
7856 }
7857
~ASTMutationListener()7858 ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7859
DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl * FD,QualType ReturnType)7860 void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7861 QualType ReturnType) {}
7862
7863 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7864 // Builtin Type Computation
7865 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7866
7867 /// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
7868 /// pointer over the consumed characters. This returns the resultant type. If
7869 /// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7870 /// types. This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7871 /// a vector of "i*".
7872 ///
7873 /// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7874 /// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
DecodeTypeFromStr(const char * & Str,const ASTContext & Context,ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError & Error,bool & RequiresICE,bool AllowTypeModifiers)7875 static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
7876 ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
7877 bool &RequiresICE,
7878 bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
7879 // Modifiers.
7880 int HowLong = 0;
7881 bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
7882 RequiresICE = false;
7883
7884 // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
7885 bool Done = false;
7886 while (!Done) {
7887 switch (*Str++) {
7888 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7889 case 'I':
7890 RequiresICE = true;
7891 break;
7892 case 'S':
7893 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7894 assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7895 Signed = true;
7896 break;
7897 case 'U':
7898 assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7899 assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
7900 Unsigned = true;
7901 break;
7902 case 'L':
7903 assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7904 ++HowLong;
7905 break;
7906 case 'W':
7907 // This modifier represents int64 type.
7908 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7909 switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7910 default:
7911 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7912 case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
7913 HowLong = 1;
7914 break;
7915 case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
7916 HowLong = 2;
7917 break;
7918 }
7919 }
7920 }
7921
7922 QualType Type;
7923
7924 // Read the base type.
7925 switch (*Str++) {
7926 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
7927 case 'v':
7928 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7929 "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7930 Type = Context.VoidTy;
7931 break;
7932 case 'h':
7933 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7934 "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
7935 Type = Context.HalfTy;
7936 break;
7937 case 'f':
7938 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7939 "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7940 Type = Context.FloatTy;
7941 break;
7942 case 'd':
7943 assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7944 "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7945 if (HowLong)
7946 Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7947 else
7948 Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7949 break;
7950 case 's':
7951 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7952 if (Unsigned)
7953 Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7954 else
7955 Type = Context.ShortTy;
7956 break;
7957 case 'i':
7958 if (HowLong == 3)
7959 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7960 else if (HowLong == 2)
7961 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7962 else if (HowLong == 1)
7963 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7964 else
7965 Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7966 break;
7967 case 'c':
7968 assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7969 if (Signed)
7970 Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7971 else if (Unsigned)
7972 Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7973 else
7974 Type = Context.CharTy;
7975 break;
7976 case 'b': // boolean
7977 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7978 Type = Context.BoolTy;
7979 break;
7980 case 'z': // size_t.
7981 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7982 Type = Context.getSizeType();
7983 break;
7984 case 'F':
7985 Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7986 break;
7987 case 'G':
7988 Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7989 break;
7990 case 'H':
7991 Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7992 break;
7993 case 'M':
7994 Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7995 break;
7996 case 'a':
7997 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7998 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7999 break;
8000 case 'A':
8001 // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
8002 // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
8003 // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
8004 // passed by reference. An example of a by-value va_list is
8005 // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
8006 // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
8007 // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
8008 // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
8009 Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
8010 assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
8011 if (Type->isArrayType())
8012 Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
8013 else
8014 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
8015 break;
8016 case 'V': {
8017 char *End;
8018 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8019 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
8020 Str = End;
8021
8022 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
8023 RequiresICE, false);
8024 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
8025
8026 // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
8027 Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
8028 VectorType::GenericVector);
8029 break;
8030 }
8031 case 'E': {
8032 char *End;
8033
8034 unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8035 assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
8036
8037 Str = End;
8038
8039 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8040 false);
8041 Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
8042 break;
8043 }
8044 case 'X': {
8045 QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
8046 false);
8047 assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
8048 Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
8049 break;
8050 }
8051 case 'Y' : {
8052 Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
8053 break;
8054 }
8055 case 'P':
8056 Type = Context.getFILEType();
8057 if (Type.isNull()) {
8058 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
8059 return QualType();
8060 }
8061 break;
8062 case 'J':
8063 if (Signed)
8064 Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
8065 else
8066 Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
8067
8068 if (Type.isNull()) {
8069 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
8070 return QualType();
8071 }
8072 break;
8073 case 'K':
8074 assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
8075 Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
8076
8077 if (Type.isNull()) {
8078 Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
8079 return QualType();
8080 }
8081 break;
8082 case 'p':
8083 Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
8084 break;
8085 }
8086
8087 // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
8088 Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
8089 while (!Done) {
8090 switch (char c = *Str++) {
8091 default: Done = true; --Str; break;
8092 case '*':
8093 case '&': {
8094 // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
8095 // qualified with an address space.
8096 char *End;
8097 unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
8098 if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
8099 Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
8100 Str = End;
8101 }
8102 if (c == '*')
8103 Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
8104 else
8105 Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
8106 break;
8107 }
8108 // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
8109 case 'C':
8110 Type = Type.withConst();
8111 break;
8112 case 'D':
8113 Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
8114 break;
8115 case 'R':
8116 Type = Type.withRestrict();
8117 break;
8118 }
8119 }
8120
8121 assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
8122 "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
8123
8124 return Type;
8125 }
8126
8127 /// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,GetBuiltinTypeError & Error,unsigned * IntegerConstantArgs) const8128 QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
8129 GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
8130 unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
8131 const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
8132
8133 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
8134
8135 bool RequiresICE = false;
8136 Error = GE_None;
8137 QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
8138 RequiresICE, true);
8139 if (Error != GE_None)
8140 return QualType();
8141
8142 assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
8143
8144 while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
8145 QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
8146 if (Error != GE_None)
8147 return QualType();
8148
8149 // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
8150 // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
8151 if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
8152 *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
8153
8154 // Do array -> pointer decay. The builtin should use the decayed type.
8155 if (Ty->isArrayType())
8156 Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
8157
8158 ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
8159 }
8160
8161 if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
8162 return QualType();
8163
8164 assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
8165 "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
8166
8167 FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
8168 if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
8169
8170 bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
8171
8172 // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
8173 if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
8174 return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
8175
8176 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
8177 EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
8178 EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
8179
8180 return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
8181 }
8182
basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext & Context,const FunctionDecl * FD)8183 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
8184 const FunctionDecl *FD) {
8185 if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
8186 return GVA_Internal;
8187
8188 GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8189 switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
8190 case TSK_Undeclared:
8191 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
8192 External = GVA_StrongExternal;
8193 break;
8194
8195 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
8196 return GVA_StrongODR;
8197
8198 // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
8199 // [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
8200 // an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
8201 // instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
8202 // inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
8203 // generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
8204 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
8205 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8206
8207 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
8208 External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
8209 break;
8210 }
8211
8212 if (!FD->isInlined())
8213 return External;
8214
8215 if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
8216 !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
8217 FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
8218 // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
8219
8220 // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
8221 // externally visible.
8222 if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
8223 return External;
8224
8225 // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
8226 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8227 }
8228
8229 // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
8230 // forcibly get emitted. While the body of the function cannot be later
8231 // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
8232 if (FD->isMSExternInline())
8233 return GVA_StrongODR;
8234
8235 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8236 }
8237
adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L,const Decl * D)8238 static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
8239 // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
8240 // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
8241 if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
8242 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
8243 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8244 } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
8245 if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8246 return GVA_StrongODR;
8247 }
8248 return L;
8249 }
8250
GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl * FD) const8251 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
8252 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
8253 FD);
8254 }
8255
basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext & Context,const VarDecl * VD)8256 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
8257 const VarDecl *VD) {
8258 if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
8259 return GVA_Internal;
8260
8261 if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
8262 GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
8263 const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
8264 while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
8265 LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
8266
8267 // Let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the nearest
8268 // enclosing function.
8269 if (LexicalContext)
8270 StaticLocalLinkage =
8271 Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
8272
8273 // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
8274 // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
8275 // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
8276 return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
8277 : StaticLocalLinkage;
8278 }
8279
8280 // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
8281 // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
8282 // cause link errors.
8283 if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8284 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8285
8286 switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
8287 case TSK_Undeclared:
8288 case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
8289 return GVA_StrongExternal;
8290
8291 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
8292 return GVA_StrongODR;
8293
8294 case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
8295 return GVA_AvailableExternally;
8296
8297 case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
8298 return GVA_DiscardableODR;
8299 }
8300
8301 llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
8302 }
8303
GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl * VD)8304 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
8305 return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
8306 VD);
8307 }
8308
DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl * D)8309 bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
8310 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
8311 if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
8312 return false;
8313 // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
8314 if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
8315 return false;
8316 } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8317 // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
8318 if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
8319 return false;
8320 } else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
8321 return true;
8322 else
8323 return false;
8324
8325 // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
8326 if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
8327 return false;
8328
8329 // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
8330 if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
8331 return false;
8332
8333 // Aliases and used decls are required.
8334 if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
8335 return true;
8336
8337 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8338 // Forward declarations aren't required.
8339 if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
8340 return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
8341
8342 // Constructors and destructors are required.
8343 if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
8344 return true;
8345
8346 // The key function for a class is required. This rule only comes
8347 // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
8348 if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
8349 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8350 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
8351 if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
8352 const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
8353 if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
8354 return true;
8355 }
8356 }
8357 }
8358
8359 GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
8360
8361 // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
8362 // always be deferred. Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
8363 // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
8364 if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
8365 Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8366 return false;
8367 return true;
8368 }
8369
8370 const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
8371 assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
8372
8373 if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
8374 !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8375 return false;
8376
8377 // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
8378 GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
8379 if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
8380 L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
8381 return true;
8382
8383 // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
8384 if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
8385 return true;
8386
8387 // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
8388 if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
8389 return true;
8390
8391 return false;
8392 }
8393
getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,bool IsCXXMethod) const8394 CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
8395 bool IsCXXMethod) const {
8396 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8397 if (IsCXXMethod)
8398 return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
8399
8400 if (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) return CC_X86StdCall;
8401
8402 return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
8403 }
8404
isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl * RD) const8405 bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
8406 // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8407 return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
8408 }
8409
getVTableContext()8410 VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
8411 if (!VTContext.get()) {
8412 if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
8413 VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
8414 else
8415 VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
8416 }
8417 return VTContext.get();
8418 }
8419
createMangleContext()8420 MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
8421 switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
8422 case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
8423 case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8424 case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
8425 case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
8426 case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
8427 case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
8428 return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
8429 case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
8430 return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
8431 }
8432 llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
8433 }
8434
~CXXABI()8435 CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
8436
getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const8437 size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
8438 return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8439 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8440 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8441 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8442 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8443 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8444 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8445 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8446 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8447 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8448 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8449 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8450 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8451 llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
8452 }
8453
8454 /// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8455 /// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8456 /// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8457 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,unsigned Signed) const8458 QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8459 unsigned Signed) const {
8460 TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8461 CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8462 if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8463 return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8464 return QualTy;
8465 }
8466
8467 /// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8468 /// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8469 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const8470 QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8471 TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8472 switch (Ty) {
8473 case TargetInfo::Float:
8474 return FloatTy;
8475 case TargetInfo::Double:
8476 return DoubleTy;
8477 case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8478 return LongDoubleTy;
8479 case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8480 return QualType();
8481 }
8482
8483 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8484 }
8485
setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl * ND,unsigned Number)8486 void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8487 if (Number > 1)
8488 MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
8489 }
8490
getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl * ND) const8491 unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8492 llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8493 MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8494 return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8495 }
8496
setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl * VD,unsigned Number)8497 void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8498 if (Number > 1)
8499 StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8500 }
8501
getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl * VD) const8502 unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8503 llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8504 StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8505 return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8506 }
8507
8508 MangleNumberingContext &
getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext * DC)8509 ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
8510 assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus); // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8511 MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8512 if (!MCtx)
8513 MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8514 return *MCtx;
8515 }
8516
createMangleNumberingContext() const8517 MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8518 return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
8519 }
8520
8521 const CXXConstructorDecl *
getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl * RD)8522 ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
8523 return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8524 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
8525 }
8526
addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl * RD,CXXConstructorDecl * CD)8527 void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
8528 CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
8529 return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8530 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
8531 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
8532 }
8533
addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl * CD,unsigned ParmIdx,Expr * DAE)8534 void ASTContext::addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8535 unsigned ParmIdx, Expr *DAE) {
8536 ABI->addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8537 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx, DAE);
8538 }
8539
getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl * CD,unsigned ParmIdx)8540 Expr *ASTContext::getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8541 unsigned ParmIdx) {
8542 return ABI->getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8543 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx);
8544 }
8545
setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl * D,unsigned int index)8546 void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8547 ParamIndices[D] = index;
8548 }
8549
getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl * D) const8550 unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8551 ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8552 assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8553 "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8554 return I->second;
8555 }
8556
8557 APValue *
getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr * E,bool MayCreate)8558 ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8559 bool MayCreate) {
8560 assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8561 "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8562 if (MayCreate)
8563 return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8564
8565 llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8566 MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
8567 return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? nullptr : &I->second;
8568 }
8569
AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr * E) const8570 bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8571 const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8572 if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8573 return false;
8574
8575 if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8576 !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8577 return false;
8578
8579 QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8580 CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8581 uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8582 CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8583 unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8584 unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8585 return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8586 }
8587
8588 namespace {
8589
8590 /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8591 /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8592 ///
8593 /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8594 /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8595 /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8596 ///
8597 /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8598 class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8599
8600 public:
8601 /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8602 ///
8603 /// The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl & TU)8604 static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8605 ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8606 Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8607 return Visitor.Parents;
8608 }
8609
8610 private:
8611 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8612
ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap * Parents)8613 ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8614 }
8615
shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const8616 bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8617 return true;
8618 }
shouldVisitImplicitCode() const8619 bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8620 return true;
8621 }
8622 // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8623 // are not triggered during data recursion.
shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt * S) const8624 bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8625 return false;
8626 }
8627
8628 template <typename T>
TraverseNode(T * Node,bool (VisitorBase::* traverse)(T *))8629 bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
8630 if (!Node)
8631 return true;
8632 if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
8633 // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8634 // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8635 // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8636 // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8637 // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8638 // new matches.
8639 // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8640 // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8641 // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8642 // do not have pointer identity.
8643 auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[Node];
8644 if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
8645 NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
8646 } else {
8647 if (NodeOrVector.template is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8648 auto *Node =
8649 NodeOrVector.template get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
8650 auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(1, *Node);
8651 NodeOrVector = Vector;
8652 delete Node;
8653 }
8654 assert(NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>());
8655
8656 auto *Vector =
8657 NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8658 // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8659 // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8660 // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8661 // types.
8662 bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8663 std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8664 ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8665 if (!Found)
8666 Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
8667 }
8668 }
8669 ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8670 bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8671 ParentStack.pop_back();
8672 return Result;
8673 }
8674
TraverseDecl(Decl * DeclNode)8675 bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8676 return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8677 }
8678
TraverseStmt(Stmt * StmtNode)8679 bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8680 return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8681 }
8682
8683 ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8684 llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8685
8686 friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8687 };
8688
8689 } // end namespace
8690
8691 ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>
getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode & Node)8692 ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8693 assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8694 "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8695 "used in the parent map.");
8696 if (!AllParents) {
8697 // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8698 // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8699 AllParents.reset(
8700 ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8701 }
8702 ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8703 if (I == AllParents->end()) {
8704 return None;
8705 }
8706 if (auto *N = I->second.dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8707 return llvm::makeArrayRef(N, 1);
8708 }
8709 return *I->second.get<ParentVector *>();
8710 }
8711
8712 bool
ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl * MethodDecl,const ObjCMethodDecl * MethodImpl)8713 ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8714 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8715 // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8716 if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8717 || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8718 return false;
8719 if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8720 MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8721 return false;
8722 if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
8723 return false;
8724
8725 if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8726 return false;
8727
8728 for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8729 IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8730 EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8731 IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8732 const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8733 const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8734 if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8735 return false;
8736 if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8737 return false;
8738 }
8739 return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8740
8741 }
8742
8743 // Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
8744 // doesn't include ASTContext.h
8745 template
8746 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8747 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
8748 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8749 const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
8750 const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);
8751